Sony A7iii
Sony A7iii
Sony A7iii
Use this manual if you encounter any problems, or have any questions about your product.
If you use two memory-card slots, you can automatically switch to recording with the other memory
card when the memory card in use becomes full.
You can record the location information on the images. The location information can be acquired via
a smartphone.
This website provides the lens compatibility information. (Another window will open.)
Names of parts
Front side
1
Rear side
Bottom
Basic operations
2
Attaching a lens
Attaching/removing a lens
Attaching accessories
Mount Adaptor
Vertical grip
In-Camera Guide
Shooting
Focusing
Focus Mode
Auto focus
Focus Area
Phase detection AF
Focus Standard
Focus Settings
Adjusting the focus area settings to the camera’s orientation (horizontal/vertical) (Swt. V/H AF Area)
AF/MF control
AF On
Face/Eye AF Set.
Center Lock-on AF
Focus Hold
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
3
Eye-Start AF (still image)
AF Micro Adj.
Manual focus
Manual Focus
Focus Magnifier
Peaking Setting
Drive Mode
Cont. Shooting
Self-timer
Self-timer(Cont)
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
WB bracket
DRO Bracket
Bracket Settings
4
Interval shooting
Touch Operation
Touch Panel/Pad
Touch Focus
APS-C/Super 35mm
Angle of view
Intelligent Auto
Program Auto
Aperture Priority
Shutter Priority
Manual Exposure
Bulb shooting
Scene Selection
Exposure Comp.
5
Reset EV Comp.
Dial Ev Comp
Exposure step
Metering Mode
AE lock
Exp.comp.set
Zebra Setting
Auto HDR
ISO
Zoom Setting
White balance
White Balance
Creative Style
6
Picture Effect
Shutter settings
Reducing blur
SteadyShot
SteadyShot Settings
Lens compensation
Lens Comp.
Noise reduction
Face detection
Flash Mode
Flash Comp.
FEL lock
Wireless Flash
Recording movies
7
Shooting movies
Movie w/ shutter
S&Q Settings
Proxy Recording
Audio Recording
Picture Profile
TC/UB Settings
MOVIE Button
Viewing
Viewing images
8
Enlarge Init. Mag.
Volume Settings
Photo Capture
Setting the method for jumping between images (Image Jump Setting)
Display as Group
Protecting data
Rating
Deleting images
Delete confirm.
Viewing images on a TV
9
Select Media (Memory recall)
Dial Setup
Av/Tv Rotate
Function Ring(Lens)
Add Item
Sort Item
Delete Item
Delete Page
Delete All
Auto Review
Aperture Preview
Monitor/viewfinder settings
Grid Line
FINDER/MONITOR
Monitor Brightness
Viewfinder Bright.
Display Quality
Bright Monitoring
10
Format
File Number
New Folder
Folder Name
Recover Image DB
Camera settings
Audio signals
IR Remote Ctrl
NTSC/PAL Selector
HDMI Settings: 24p/60p Output (movie) (Only for 1080 60i compatible models)
USB Connection
Language
Date/Time Setup
11
Area Setting
Copyright Info
Version
Demo Mode
Setting Reset
PlayMemories Mobile
Send to Computer
Transferring images to a TV
View on TV
Airplane Mode
12
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
Using a computer
PlayMemories Home
Connecting to a computer
Imaging Edge
Creating DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) from high-definition image quality movies
Camera Settings1
APS-C/Super 35mm
13
Long Exposure NR (still image)
Lens Comp.
Scene Selection
Drive Mode
Bracket Settings
Focus Mode
Focus Area
Focus Settings
Adjusting the focus area settings to the camera’s orientation (horizontal/vertical) (Swt. V/H AF Area)
Center Lock-on AF
Face/Eye AF Set.
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
14
Disp. cont. AF area
AF Micro Adj.
Exposure Comp.
Reset EV Comp.
ISO
Metering Mode
Exposure step
Flash Mode
Flash Comp.
Exp.comp.set
Wireless Flash
White Balance
Auto HDR
Creative Style
Picture Effect
Picture Profile
Focus Magnifier
15
Peaking Setting
Camera Settings2
S&Q Settings
Proxy Recording
Audio Recording
Movie w/ shutter
SteadyShot
16
SteadyShot Settings
Zoom Setting
FINDER/MONITOR
Zebra Setting
Grid Line
Auto Review
Dial Setup
Av/Tv Rotate
Dial Ev Comp
MOVIE Button
Audio signals
Function Ring(Lens)
Network
Send to Computer
View on TV
Ctrl w/ Smartphone
Airplane Mode
17
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
Bluetooth Settings
Playback
Rating
Photo Capture
Display as Group
Setting the method for jumping between images (Image Jump Setting)
18
Setup
Monitor Brightness
Viewfinder Bright.
Volume Settings
Delete confirm.
Display Quality
NTSC/PAL Selector
Cleaning Mode
Touch Operation
Touch Panel/Pad
Demo Mode
TC/UB Settings
IR Remote Ctrl
HDMI Settings: 24p/60p Output (movie) (Only for 1080 60i compatible models)
USB Connection
19
Language
Date/Time Setup
Area Setting
Copyright Info
Format
File Number
New Folder
Folder Name
Recover Image DB
Version
Setting Reset
My Menu
Add Item
Sort Item
Delete Item
Delete Page
Delete All
Precautions/This product
Precautions
On cleaning
Cleaning Mode
20
Using the AC Adaptor/battery charger abroad
AVCHD format
License
Specifications
Trademarks
Troubleshooting
Warning messages
21
Help Guide
Front side
7. AF illuminator/Self-timer lamp
8. Mounting index
9. Image sensor*
10. Mount
11. Lens contacts*
22
Help Guide
Rear side
1. Eyepiece Cup
Remove the eyepiece cup when attaching an angle viewfinder (sold separately). Also, select MENU →
(Camera Settings2) → [FINDER/MONITOR], and then switch to [Viewfinder(Manual)] or [Monitor(Manual)].
2. Viewfinder
3. C3 button (Custom button 3)/ (Protect) button
4. MENU button
5. Monitor (For touch operation: Touch panel/Touch pad)
You can adjust the monitor to an easily viewable angle and shoot from any position.
23
6. Eye sensor
7. Diopter-adjustment dial
Adjust the diopter-adjustment dial according to your eyesight until the display appears clearly in the viewfinder. If it is
hard to operate the diopter-adjustment dial, remove the eyepiece cup before operating the dial.
24
Help Guide
If the subject is closer than the minimum shooting distance of the lens, the focus cannot be confirmed. Make sure
you put enough distance between the subject and the camera.
2. Speaker
3. (Microphone) jack
When an external microphone is connected, the built-in microphone turns off automatically. When the external
microphone is a plugin-power type, the power of the microphone is supplied by the camera.
4. (Headphones) jack
5. HDMI micro jack
6. USB Type-C terminal
25
7. Charge lamp
8. Multi/Micro USB Terminal*
This terminal supports Micro USB-compatible devices.
15. (N mark)
This mark indicates the touch point for connecting the camera and an NFC-enabled Smartphone.
NFC (Near Field Communication) is an international standard of short-range wireless communication technology.
* For details on compatible accessories for the multi interface shoe and the Multi/Micro USB Terminal, visit the Sony website, or consult your Sony
dealer or local authorized Sony service facility. Accessories for the Accessory Shoe can also be used. Operations with other manufactures’
accessories are not guaranteed.
26
Notes on USB terminals
You can use either the USB Type-C terminal or the Multi/Micro USB Terminal for supplying power, charging the battery,
and USB communications. However, you cannot conduct these operations with both terminals simultaneously.
The battery charging time does not change according to the terminal you use.
You can use accessories for the Multi/Micro USB Terminal, such as a remote commander (sold separately), while
supplying power or performing PC Remote shooting using the USB Type-C terminal.
27
Help Guide
Bottom
28
Help Guide
1. Focusing ring
2. Zoom ring
3. Focal-length scale
4. Focal-length index
5. Lens contacts
Do not touch this part directly.
6. Mount index
29
Help Guide
You can select setting items by turning or pressing the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel. Your selection is
determined when you press the center of the control wheel.
The DISP (Display Setting), / (Drive Mode), and ISO (ISO) functions are assigned to the top/left/right side of
the control wheel. In addition, you can assign selected functions to the left/right/bottom side and the center of the
control wheel, and to the rotation of the control wheel.
During playback, you can display the next/previous image by pressing the right/left side of the control wheel or by
turning the control wheel.
Related Topic
Focus Standard
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
30
Help Guide
Put your finger right on top of the multi-selector to manipulate it more precisely.
When [Focus Area] is set to [Zone], [Flexible Spot], or [Expand Flexible Spot], you can move the focus area by
pressing the multi-selector up/down/left/right.
The [Focus Standard] function is assigned to the center of the multi-selector in the default settings.
Related Topic
Focus Area
Focus Standard
31
Help Guide
You can change settings related to all the camera operations including shooting, playback, and operating method. You
can also execute camera functions from the MENU.
2 Select the desired setting you want to adjust using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control wheel or by
turning the control wheel, and then press the center of the control wheel.
Select an icon at the top of the screen (A) and press the left/right side of the control wheel to move to another
MENU tab.
You can move to the next MENU tab by pressing the Fn button. (This function can be used when the camera’s
system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.)
You can go back to the previous screen by pressing the MENU button (B).
3 Select the desired setting value, and press the center to confirm your selection.
Hint
You can display the menu screen by assigning the [MENU] function to a custom key using [ Custom Key] or [ Custom
Key], and then pressing that key. (This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.)
32
Related Topic
Add Item
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Version
33
Help Guide
You can register frequently used functions to the Fn (Function) button and recall them while shooting. Up to 12 frequently
used functions can be registered to the Fn (Function) button.
1 Press the DISP on the control wheel repeatedly to display a screen mode other than [For viewfinder], and
then press the Fn (Function) button.
2 Select the desired function by pressing the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel.
3 Select the desired setting by turning the front dial, and press the center of the control wheel.
34
Select the desired function in step 2, then press the center of the control wheel. The dedicated setting screen for the
function will appear. Follow the operating guide (A) to adjust settings.
Related Topic
Function Menu Set.
35
Help Guide
The Quick Navi screen is a function optimized for shooting with the viewfinder, that lets you control settings directly.
3 Press the DISP on the control wheel to set the screen mode to [For viewfinder].
The displayed contents and their positions in the illustrations are just guidelines, and may differ from the actual
displays.
P/A/S/M mode
5 Select the desired function by pressing the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel.
36
Note
Items that are gray on the Quick Navi screen are not adjustable.
When using [Creative Style], [Picture Profile], etc., some of the setup tasks can only be accomplished on a dedicated screen.
Related Topic
Switching the screen display (while shooting/during playback)
37
Help Guide
Move the cursor on desired key using the control wheel, then press the center to enter.
1. Input box
The characters you entered are displayed.
2. Switch character types
Each time you press this key, the character type will switch between alphabet letters, numerals and symbols.
3. Keyboard
Each time you press this key, the characters corresponding to that key will be displayed one-by-one in order.
For example: If you want to enter “abd”
Press the key for “abc” once to display “a” → select “ ”((5) Move cursor) and press the key for “abc” twice to
display “b” → press the key for “def” once to display “d.”
4. Finalize
Finalizes the entered characters.
5. Move cursor
Moves the cursor in the input box to the right or left.
6. Delete
Deletes the character preceding the cursor.
7.
Switches the next character to a capital or lowercase letter.
8.
Enters a space.
To cancel input, select [Cancel].
38
Help Guide
The displayed contents and their positions in the illustrations are just guidelines, and may differ from the actual displays.
Monitor mode
Viewfinder mode
Register number
Scene Selection
2. Camera settings
NO CARD
Memory card status
100
Remaining number of recordable images
39
24M / 20M / 10M / 8.7M / 6.0M / 5.1M / 2.6M / 2.2M
Image size of still images
JPEG Quality
Proxy Recording
120fps 60fps 30fps 15fps 8fps 4fps 100fps 50fps 25fps 12fps 6fps 3fps 2fps 1fps
Frame rate for slow/quick motion shooting
APS-C/Super 35mm
AF Illuminator
Flickering detected
PC remote
Bright Monitoring
Silent Shooting
Remote control
40
Focus Cancel
Lock-on AF Cancel
Spot Focus
Performing [Spot Focus]
NFC active
Airplane Mode
Overheating warning
Remaining battery
Drive Mode
Focus Mode
File Format
Focus Area
Metering Mode
7500K A5 G5
White Balance (Auto, Preset, Underwater Auto, Custom, Color temperature, Color filter)
Picture Effect
Face/Eye Prty in AF
–
Picture Profile
41
Prioritize Rec. Media
5. Focus indicator/exposure settings
Focus indicator
1/250
Shutter speed
F3.5
Aperture value
AE lock/FEL lock
6. Guides/other
Lock-on AF
Lock-on AF Cancel
Guide display for Lock-on AF
Focus Cancel
Guide display for canceling focusing
Bracket indicator
Aperture indicator
Histogram
REC Control
00:00:00:00
Time code (hours: minutes: seconds: frames)
00 00 00 00
User Bit
Single-image playback
42
Histogram display
1. Basic information
Playback media
View Mode
Rating
Protect
DPOF
DPOF set
3/7
File number/Number of images in the view mode
NFC active
Remaining battery
Display as Group
3. Shooting settings
43
HLG
HDR recording (Hybrid Log-Gamma)
Refer to “Icons on the shooting screen” for other icons displayed in this area.
4. Image information
Latitude/longitude information
2018-1-1 10:37AM
Date of recording
100-0003
Folder number - file number
Histogram (Luminance/R/G/B)
44
Help Guide
To switch the information displayed on the viewfinder, press the DISP button while looking into the viewfinder.
Each time you press the DISP button, the screen display changes.
The displayed contents and their position are just a guideline, and may differ from the actual display.
45
If the image has an overexposed or underexposed area, the corresponding section will blink on the histogram
display (overexposed/underexposed warning).
The settings for playback are also applied in [Auto Review].
Histogram display
A histogram shows the luminance distribution, displaying how many pixels there are by luminance. It shows darker
toward the left and brighter toward the right.
The histogram changes depending on the exposure compensation.
A peak at the right or left end of the histogram indicates that the image has an overexposed or underexposed area,
respectively. You cannot correct such defects using a computer after shooting. Perform exposure compensation before
shooting as necessary.
Note
The viewfinder display and the monitor display for shooting can be set separately. Look through the viewfinder to set the display
settings for the viewfinder.
The information in the histogram display does not indicate the final photograph. It is information about image displayed on the
screen. The final result depends on the aperture value, etc.
The histogram display is extremely different between shooting and playback in the following cases:
When the flash is used
When shooting a low luminance subject such as a night scene
Hint
The following are not displayed in the default settings.
Graphic Display
Monitor Off
Display All Info. (when using the viewfinder)
To change the display modes that are switched when you press the DISP button, select MENU → (Camera Settings2) →
[DISP Button] and change the setting.
Related Topic
46
DISP Button (Monitor/Finder)
47
Help Guide
Allows you to set the screen display modes that can be selected using DISP (Display Setting) in shooting mode.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [DISP Button] → [Monitor] or [Finder] → desired setting → [Enter].
For viewfinder*:
Displays only shooting information on the monitor, not the subject. This setting is a display setting for shooting with the
viewfinder.
Monitor Off*:
Always turns the monitor off when shooting images. You can use the monitor when playing back images or operating
MENU. This setting is a display setting for shooting with the viewfinder.
* These screen modes are available only in the setting for [Monitor].
Note
If you tilt the product forward or backward by a large degree, the level error will be great.
The product may have a margin of error of almost ±1° even when the inclination is corrected by the level.
48
Related Topic
Switching the screen display (while shooting/during playback)
49
Help Guide
First check the model name of your camera. The accessories supplied differ depending on the model.
The number in parentheses indicates the number of pieces.
* Multiple power cords may be supplied with your camera. Use the appropriate one that matches your country/region.
Rechargeable Battery Pack NP-FZ100 (1)
ILCE-7M3K
FE 28-70 mm F3.5-5.6 OSS zoom lens (1) (including front lens cap and rear lens cap)
Lens Hood (1)
50
4-732-947-15(1) Copyright 2018 Sony Corporation
51
Help Guide
2 Insert the battery pack while pressing the lock lever (A) with the tip of the battery until the battery locks into
place.
52
Help Guide
2 Connect the camera with the battery pack inserted to the AC Adaptor (supplied) using the USB cable, and
connect the AC Adaptor to the wall outlet (wall socket).
Charging time (Full charge): The charging time is approximately 285 min.
The above charging time applies when charging a fully depleted battery pack at a temperature of 25 °C (77 °F).
Charging may take longer depending on conditions of use and circumstances.
The charge lamp turns off when charging is completed.
If the charge lamp lights up and then immediately turns off, the battery pack is fully charged.
Note
If the charge lamp flashes when the battery pack is not fully charged, remove the battery pack or disconnect the USB cable from
the camera and then re-insert it to recharge.
If the charge lamp on the camera flashes when the AC Adaptor is connected to the wall outlet (wall socket), this indicates that
charging is temporarily stopped because the temperature is outside the recommended range. When the temperature gets back
within the appropriate range, the charging resumes. We recommend charging the battery pack at an ambient temperature of
between 10°C to 30°C (50ºF to 86ºF).
Use a nearby wall outlet (wall socket) when using the AC Adaptor/Battery Charger. If any malfunction occurs, disconnect the plug
from the wall outlet (wall socket) immediately to disconnect from the power source.
If you use the product with a charge lamp, note that the product is not disconnected from the power source even when the lamp
turns off.
If you turn on the camera, power will be supplied from the wall outlet (wall socket) and you will be able to operate the camera.
However, the battery pack will not be charged.
When you use a completely new battery pack or a battery pack that has not been used for a long time, the charge lamp may flash
quickly when the battery is charged. If this happens, remove the battery pack or disconnect the USB cable from the camera and
then re-insert it to recharge.
53
Do not continuously or repeatedly charge the battery pack without using it if it is already fully charged or close to fully charged.
Doing so may cause a deterioration in battery performance.
When charging is finished, disconnect the AC Adaptor from the wall outlet (wall socket).
Be sure to use only genuine Sony brand battery packs and AC Adaptors.
The charging time is the same even when using the USB Type-C cable.
Related Topic
Notes on the battery pack
Notes on charging the battery pack
Using the AC Adaptor/battery charger abroad
54
Help Guide
The battery pack can be charged by connecting the camera to a computer using a USB cable.
1 Turn off the product, and connect to the USB terminal of the computer.
Note
If the product is connected to a laptop computer that is not connected to a power source, the laptop battery level decreases. Do
not leave the product connected to a laptop computer for an extended period of time.
Do not turn on/off or restart the computer, or wake the computer from sleep mode when a USB connection has been established
between the computer and the camera. Doing so may cause a malfunction. Before turning on/off or restarting the computer, or
waking the computer from sleep mode, disconnect the camera from the computer.
Charging cannot be guaranteed with a custom-built computer, modified computer, or a computer connected through a USB hub.
The camera may not operate correctly when other USB devices are used at the same time.
Related Topic
Notes on the battery pack
Notes on charging the battery pack
55
Help Guide
Note
The above estimates for battery life and number of recordable images apply when the battery pack has been fully charged. The
battery life and number of images may decrease depending on the conditions of use.
The battery life and number of recordable images are estimates based on shooting with the default settings under the following
conditions:
Using the battery pack at an ambient temperature of 25°C (77°F).
Using a Sony SDXC memory card (U3) (sold separately)
Using a FE 28-70mm F3.5-5.6 OSS lens
The numbers for “Shooting (still images)” are based on the CIPA standard and shooting under the following conditions:
(CIPA: Camera & Imaging Products Association)
One picture is taken every 30 seconds.
The power is turned on and off once every ten times.
The number of minutes for movie shooting is based on the CIPA standard and shooting under the following conditions:
The image quality is set to XAVC S HD 60p 50M /50p 50M.
Actual shooting (movies): Battery life based on repeated shooting, zooming, shooting stand-by, turning on/off, etc.
Continuous shooting (movies): Battery life based on non-stop shooting until the limit (29 minutes) has been reached, and then
continued by pressing the MOVIE (Movie) button again. Other functions, such as zooming, are not operated.
56
Help Guide
Use the supplied AC adaptor to shoot and play back images while power is supplied from a wall outlet (wall socket). This
conserves the camera's battery power.
2 Connect the camera to the wall outlet (wall socket) with a USB cable and the AC adaptor (supplied).
Note
The camera will not activate if there is no remaining battery. Insert a sufficiently charged battery pack into the camera.
If you use the camera while power is being supplied from a wall outlet (wall socket), make sure that the icon that shows that
powering via USB is in progress ( ) is displayed on the monitor.
Do not remove the battery pack while power is supplied from a wall outlet (wall socket). If you remove the battery pack, the
camera will be turned off.
Do not remove the battery pack while the access lamp is lit. The data in the memory card may be damaged.
As long as the power is on, the battery pack will not be charged even if the camera is connected to the AC Adaptor.
Under certain conditions, power may be supplied from the battery pack supplementarily even if you are using the AC adaptor.
Do not remove the USB cable while power is supplied from a wall outlet (wall socket). Before you remove the USB cable, turn off
the camera.
Depending on the camera and battery temperature, the continuous recording time may be shortened while power is supplied
from a wall outlet (wall socket).
When using a mobile charger as a power source, confirm that it is fully charged before use. Also, be careful of the remaining
power on the mobile charger during use.
57
Help Guide
Charge the battery pack (supplied) before using the product for the first time.
The charged battery pack will discharge little by little even if you do not use it. Charge the battery pack each time
before you use the product so that you do not miss any opportunities to shoot images.
Do not charge battery packs except battery packs specified for this product. Doing so can result in leaks,
overheating, explosions, electric shocks, burns, or injuries.
If the charge lamp flashes when the battery pack is not fully charged, remove the battery pack or disconnect the USB
cable from the camera and then reinsert it to recharge.
We recommend charging the battery pack in an ambient temperature of between 10 °C and 30 °C (50 °F and 86 °F).
The battery pack may not be effectively charged in temperatures outside this range.
When you connect this product and a laptop computer that is not connected to a power source, the laptop’s battery
charge may decrease. Do not charge this product using the laptop computer for too long.
Do not turn on/restart a computer, wake a computer from sleep mode, or turn off a computer while this product is
connected to the computer via USB cable. Doing so may cause a malfunction of this product. Disconnect the product
and the computer before performing the above operations.
We do not guarantee charging if you are using a self-built or modified computer.
When charging is finished, disconnect the AC Adaptor from the wall outlet (wall socket) or disconnect the USB cable
from the camera. Not doing so may result in a shorter battery life.
It takes about one minute for the correct remaining battery indicator to appear.
The correct remaining battery indicator may not be displayed under some operating or environmental conditions.
If the remaining battery indicator does not appear on the screen, press the DISP (Display Setting) button to display it.
58
Battery performance decreases in low temperature environments. So in cold places, the operational time of the
battery pack is shorter. To ensure longer battery pack use, we recommend putting the battery pack in your pocket
close to your body to warm it up, and insert it in the product immediately before you start shooting. If there are any
metal objects such as keys in your pocket, be careful of causing a short-circuit.
The battery pack will run down quickly if you use the flash or continuous shooting function frequently, turn the power
on/off frequently, or set the monitor very bright.
We recommend preparing spare battery packs and taking trial shots before taking the actual shots.
If the battery terminal is dirty, you may not be able to turn on the product or the battery pack may not be properly
charged. In that case, clean the battery by lightly wiping off any dust using a soft cloth or a cotton swab.
To maintain the battery pack’s function, charge the battery pack and then fully discharge it in the camera at least once a
year before storing it. Store the battery in a cool, dry place after removing it from the camera.
On battery life
The battery life is limited. If you use the same battery repeatedly, or use the same battery for a long period, the
battery capacity decreases gradually. If the available time of the battery is shortened significantly, it is probably time
to replace the battery pack with a new one.
The battery life varies according to how the battery pack is stored and the operating conditions and environment in
which each battery pack is used.
59
Help Guide
The supplied AC Adaptor is dedicated to this product. Do not connect with other electronic devices. Doing so may
cause a malfunction.
Make sure to use a genuine Sony AC Adaptor.
If the product's charge lamp flashes while charging, remove the battery pack being charged, and then insert the
same battery pack firmly back into the product. If the charge lamp flashes again, this may indicate a faulty battery or
that a battery pack other than the specified type has been inserted. Check that the battery pack is the specified type.
If the battery pack is the specified type, remove the battery pack, replace it with a new or different one and check that
the newly inserted battery is charging correctly. If the newly inserted battery is charging correctly, the previously
inserted battery may be faulty.
If the charge lamp flashes even if the AC Adaptor is connected to the product and the wall outlet (wall socket), this
indicates that charging has stopped temporarily and is on standby. Charging stops and enters standby status
automatically when the temperature is outside of the recommended operating temperature. When the temperature
returns to the appropriate range, charging resumes and the charge lamp lights up again. We recommend charging
the battery pack in an ambient temperature of between 10°C to 30°C (50°F to 86°F).
60
Help Guide
When using two memory cards, insert the second one into the slot 2.
With the notched corner facing in the direction illustrated, insert the memory card until it clicks into place. Insert
the memory card correctly. Not doing so may cause a malfunction.
Memory card types that can be inserted into the memory card slots
Slot 1 (lower): Supports SD cards (compatible with UHS-I and UHS-II)
Slot 2 (upper): Supports SD cards (compatible with UHS-I) and Memory Stick PRO Duo media
Hint
61
When you use a memory card with the camera for the first time, it is recommended that you format the card on the camera for
more stable performance of the memory card.
You can change the memory card slot for recording by selecting MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] → [Prioritize
Rec. Media].
To record the same image on two memory cards at the same time or to sort recorded images onto two memory card slots by the
image type (still image/movie), select MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] → [Recording Mode].
Use the slot 1 when you are only using one SD card.
Use the slot 2 when you are using Memory Stick media. In this case, set [Prioritize Rec. Media] to [Slot 2].
Do not insert a Memory Stick media into the slot 1. It may cause a malfunction.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Notes on memory card
Format
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
Selecting which memory card to play back (Select PB Media)
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
62
Help Guide
When using microSD memory cards or Memory Stick Micro media with this camera, be sure to use the appropriate
adaptor.
SD memory cards
4K 60Mbps*
HD 50Mbps or lower* SDHC/SDXC card (Class 10, or U1 or faster)
XAVC S HD 60Mbps
4K 100Mbps*
SDHC/SDXC card (U3)
HD 100Mbps
Still image Memory Stick PRO Duo/ Memory Stick PRO-HG Duo
AVCHD Memory Stick PRO Duo (Mark 2)/ Memory Stick PRO-HG Duo
4K 60Mbps*
HD 50Mbps or lower* Memory Stick PRO-HG Duo
XAVC S HD 60Mbps
4K 100Mbps*
—
HD 100Mbps
Note
Use the slot 1 when you are using a UHS-II memory card. Also, select MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] →
[Prioritize Rec. Media] → [Slot 1].
When an SDHC memory card is used to record an XAVC S movie over extended periods of time, the recorded movies will be
divided into files 4 GB in size. The divided files can be handled as a single file by importing them to a computer using
PlayMemories Home.
When recording a movie on memory cards in both the slot 1 and the slot 2 with following camera settings, insert two memory
cards with the same file system. XAVC S movies cannot be recorded simultaneously when using a combination of the exFAT file
system and FAT32 file system.
[ File Format] is set to [XAVC S 4K] or [XAVC S HD].
[Recording Mode] under [Rec. Media Settings] is set to [Simult. ( )] or [Simult. ( / )].
63
Memory card File system
Memory Stick PRO Duo (Mark2), Memory Stick PRO-HG Duo, SDHC memory card FAT32
Fully charge the battery pack before attempting to recover the database files on the memory card.
Related Topic
Notes on memory card
Number of recordable images
Recordable movie times
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
64
Help Guide
If you repeatedly shoot and delete images for a long time, fragmentation of data in a file in the memory card may
occur, and movie recording may be interrupted in the middle of shooting. If this happens, save your images to a
computer or other storage location, then execute [Format] using this camera.
Do not remove the battery pack or the memory card, disconnect the USB cable, or turn the camera off while the
access lamp is lit up. This may cause the data on the memory card to become damaged.
Be sure to back up the data for protection.
Not all memory cards are guaranteed to operate correctly.
Images recorded on an SDXC memory card cannot be imported to or played on computers or AV devices that are
not compatible with exFAT when connected using a USB cable. Make sure that the device is compatible with exFAT
before connecting it to the camera. If you connect your camera to an incompatible device, you may be prompted to
format the card. Never format the card in response to this prompt, as doing so will erase all data on the card. (exFAT
is the file system used on SDXC memory cards.)
Do not expose the memory card to water.
Do not strike, bend or drop the memory card.
Do not use or store the memory card under the following conditions:
High temperature locations such as in a car parked under the sun
Locations exposed to direct sunlight
Humid locations or locations with corrosive substances present
If the memory card is used near areas with strong magnetization, or used in locations subject to static electricity or
electrical noise, the data on the memory card may become damaged.
Do not touch the terminal section of the memory card with your hand or a metal object.
Do not leave the memory card within the reach of small children. They might accidentally swallow it.
Do not disassemble or modify the memory card.
The memory card may be hot just after it has been used for a long time. Be careful when you handle it.
Memory card formatted with a computer is not guaranteed to operate with the product. Format the memory card
using this product.
Data read/write speeds differ depending on the combination of the memory card and the equipment used.
Do not press down hard when writing in the memo space on the memory card.
Do not attach a label on the memory card itself nor on a memory card adaptor.
If the write-protect switch or delete-protect switch of a memory card is set to the LOCK position, you cannot record or
delete images. In this case, set the switch to the record position.
To use a Memory Stick Micro media or microSD memory card with this product:
Be sure to insert the memory card into a dedicated adaptor. If you insert a memory card into the product without a
memory card adaptor, you might not be able to remove it from the product.
When inserting a memory card into a memory card adaptor, be sure that the memory card is inserted in the
correct direction and then insert it as far as it will go. If the card is not inserted properly, it may result in a
malfunction.
About Memory Stick PRO Duo media and Memory Stick PRO-HG Duo media:
This Memory Stick is equipped with MagicGate function. MagicGate is copyright protection technology that uses
encryption technology.
Data recording/playback that requires MagicGate functions cannot be performed with this product.
High-speed data transfer using a parallel interface is supported.
65
Help Guide
Attaching/removing a lens
1 Remove the body cap (A) from the camera and the rear lens cap (B) from the rear of the lens.
It is recommended that you attach the front lens cap when you have done shooting.
2 Mount the lens by aligning the two white index marks (mounting indexes) on the lens and camera.
Hold the camera with the lens mount facing down to prevent dust and debris from entering the camera.
3 While pushing the lens lightly toward the camera, turn the lens slowly in the direction of the arrow until it
clicks into the locked position.
66
Be sure to hold the lens straight when attaching it.
Note
When attaching/removing the lens, work quickly in a dust-free location.
A Mount Adaptor (sold separately) is required to use an A-mount lens (sold separately). When using the Mount Adaptor, refer to
the operating manual supplied with the Mount Adaptor.
If you want to shoot full-frame images, use a full-frame size compatible lens.
When you use a lens with a tripod socket, attach a tripod to the tripod socket of the lens to help balance the weight of the lens.
When carrying the camera with a lens attached, hold both the camera and the lens firmly.
Do not hold the part of the lens that is extended for zoom or focus adjustment.
Related Topic
Attaching the lens hood
67
Help Guide
We recommend that you use the lens hood to prevent light outside the shooting frame from affecting the image.
1 Match the shape of the lens hood mounting part and lens head, and turn the lens hood clockwise until it
clicks.
Note
Attach the lens hood properly. Otherwise, the lens hood may not have any effect or may be partially reflected in the image.
When the lens hood is attached properly, the lens hood index (red line) matches the red index mark on the hood. (There may be
no lens hood index on some lenses.)
Remove the lens hood when using the flash as the lens hood blocks the flash light and may appear as a shadow on the image.
To store the lens hood after shooting, attach the lens hood to the lens backward.
Related Topic
Attaching/removing a lens
68
Help Guide
Mount Adaptor
Using a Mount Adaptor (sold separately), you can attach an A-mount lens (sold separately) to this product.
For details, refer to the operating instructions supplied with the Mount Adaptor.
Note
When a setting other than [Continuous Shooting: Lo] is selected for [Cont. Shooting], the focus is locked during the first shot,
even if [Focus Mode] is set to [Continuous AF].
You may not be able to use the Mount Adaptor or auto-focus with certain lenses. Consult your Sony dealer or local authorized
Sony service facility on compatible lenses.
The LA-EA2 or LA-EA4 Mount Adaptor (sold separately) and the vertical grip (sold separately) are not designed to be attached at
the same time. If you attach them at the same time, the space between the Mount Adaptor and the vertical grip will become
narrow, making the camera difficult to hold.
The sound of the lens and the product in operation may be recorded during movie recording.
You can turn the sound off by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Audio Recording] → [Off].
It may take a long time or may be difficult for the product to focus, depending on the lens used or the subject.
Related Topic
LA-EA1/LA-EA3 Mount Adaptor
LA-EA2/LA-EA4 Mount Adaptor
69
Help Guide
If you use the LA-EA1 Mount Adaptor (sold separately) or LA-EA3 Mount Adaptor (sold separately), the following
functions are available.
When using a Mount Adaptor and the camera is set to movie mode, the Auto Focus only works when the shutter
button is pressed halfway down or when the [AF On] function is active.
When using a Mount Adaptor in movie mode, adjust the aperture manually.
All types of focus area are available when the camera's system software (firmware) version is 2.00 or later.
Related Topic
Focus Area
70
Help Guide
If you use the LA-EA2 Mount Adaptor (sold separately) or LA-EA4 Mount Adaptor (sold separately), the following
functions are available.
Even if [Priority Set in AF-S] is set to [Balanced Emphasis], it will temporarily switch to [AF].
Even if [Priority Set in AF-C] is set to [Balanced Emphasis], it will temporarily switch to [Release].
71
Help Guide
Vertical grip
You can attach a vertical grip (sold separately) to this product and record vertically oriented images. When attaching the
vertical grip, remove the battery cover in advance. For details, refer to the operating instructions for the vertical grip.
You can attach the removed battery cover to the vertical grip so that you do not lose it.
When a vertical grip is attached to this product, the battery remaining is displayed as .
Hint
The battery pack inside the vertical grip can be charged while the vertical grip is attached to the camera.
Turn off the camera and connect the camera to the AC Adaptor (supplied) using the USB cable then connect the AC Adaptor to
the wall outlet (wall socket).
Note
The LA-EA2/LA-EA4 Mount Adaptor (sold separately) and the vertical grip are not designed to be attached at the same time. If
you attach them at the same time, the space between the Mount Adaptor and the vertical grip will become narrow, making the
camera difficult to hold.
72
Help Guide
The setting screen for language, date and time is displayed automatically when you turn on this product for the first time,
initialize this product or when the internal rechargeable backup battery has discharged.
The language setting screen will appear and then setting screen for date and time will appear.
2 Select your language, and then press the center of the control wheel.
3 Check that [Enter] is selected on the screen, then press the center.
4 Select your desired geographic location, and then press the center.
5 Select a setting item using the top/bottom side of the control wheel or by turning the control wheel, then
press the center.
6 Set [Daylight Savings], [Date/Time], and [Date Format] using the top/bottom/left/right sides, then press the
center.
Midnight is indicated as 12:00 AM, and noon as 12:00 PM when you set [Date/Time].
Change the values using the top/bottom when you set [Date/Time].
7 Repeat Steps 5 and 6 to set other items, then select [Enter] and press the center.
Hint
To set the date and time or geographic location again after the date and time setting is finished, select MENU → (Setup) →
[Date/Time Setup] or [Area Setting].
Note
If the date and time setting is canceled halfway, the setting screen for the date and time appears every time you turn on the
camera.
This camera does not have a function for inserting the date on images. You can insert the date on images and then save and
print them using PlayMemories Home (for Windows only).
73
Related Topic
Date/Time Setup
Area Setting
Using the control wheel
74
Help Guide
In-Camera Guide
The [In-Camera Guide] displays descriptions of MENU items, Fn (Function) items, and settings.
Assign the [In-Camera Guide] function to the desired key in advance using [ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key].
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key] → desired key, then assign
the [In-Camera Guide] function to the key.
2 Select the MENU or Fn item of which you want to see descriptions, then press the button to which the [In-
Camera Guide] function is assigned.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
75
Help Guide
2 Adjust the monitor angle, and hold the camera. Or look through the viewfinder and hold the camera.
3 When a zoom lens is mounted, enlarge images by rotating the zoom ring.
When the image is in focus, a beep sounds and the indicator (such as ) lights up.
To shoot images with the focus locked on the desired subject (Focus-lock)
Shoots images with the focus locked on the desired subject in auto focus mode.
76
The focus is locked.
If it is difficult to focus on the desired subject, set [Focus Area] to [Center] or [Flexible Spot].
3. Keep pressing the shutter button halfway down, and place the subject back in the original position to re-compose the
shot.
An icon indicating that data is being written is displayed after shooting. Do not remove the memory card while the icon is
displayed.
Note
When the subject is moving, you cannot lock the focus even if [Focus Mode] has been set to [Automatic AF].
Related Topic
List of mode dial function
Clear Image Zoom/Digital Zoom (Zoom)
Playing back still images
Auto Review
Focus Mode
Focus Area
77
Help Guide
Focus Mode
Focus indicator
(lit):
The subject is in focus and the focus is locked.
(flashing):
The subject is not in focus.
(lit):
The subject is in focus. The focus will be adjusted continuously according to the movements of the subject.
(lit):
Focusing is in progress.
Hint
In [Continuous AF] mode, you can lock the focus by pressing and holding the button that has been assigned the [Focus Hold]
function.
When you set the focus to infinity in the manual focus mode or the direct manual focus mode, make sure that the focus is on a
sufficiently distant subject by checking the monitor or the viewfinder.
78
Note
[Automatic AF] is available only when you are using a lens that supports phase detection AF.
When [Continuous AF] or [Automatic AF] is set, the angle of view may change little by little while focusing. This does not affect
the actual recorded images.
Only [Continuous AF] and [Manual Focus] are available when shooting movies or when the mode dial is set to .
Related Topic
Direct manual focus (DMF)
Manual Focus
MF Assist (still image)
Phase detection AF
79
Help Guide
Focus Area
Selects the focusing area. Use this function when it is difficult to focus properly in the auto focus mode.
80
When [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Zone], the focusing frame may switch between “When focusing on a larger
area” and “When focusing on a smaller area” depending on the subject or situation.
When you attach an A-mount lens with a Mount Adaptor (LA-EA1 or LA-EA3) (sold separately) and [ AF System]
is set to [Phase Detection AF], the focusing frame for “When focusing on a smaller area” may be displayed.
When focus is achieved automatically based on the whole range of the monitor
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, the [Focus Area] setting is disabled and the focusing
frame is shown by the dotted line. The AF operates with priority on and around the center area.
Hint
In the default settings, [Focus Area] is assigned to the C2 button.
Note
[Focus Area] is locked to [Wide] in the following situations:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
The focus area may not light up during continuous shooting or when the shutter button is pressed all the way down at once.
When the mode dial is set to (Movie) or or during movie shooting, [Lock-on AF] cannot be selected as the [Focus
Area].
When [Subject Detection] under [Face/Eye AF Set.] is set to [Animal], [Lock-on AF] cannot be selected as the [Focus Area].
Related Topic
Touch Operation
81
Adjusting the focus area settings to the camera’s orientation (horizontal/vertical) (Swt. V/H AF Area)
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
82
Help Guide
Phase detection AF
When there are phase detection AF points within the auto focus area, the product uses the combined autofocus of the
phase detection AF and contrast AF.
Note
Phase detection AF is available only when an applicable lens is attached. If you use a lens that does not support phase detection
AF, you cannot use [Automatic AF], [ AF Track Sens], [ AF Track Sens] or [ AF drive speed].
Also, even if you use a previously purchased applicable lens, the phase detection AF might not function unless you update the
lens. For details on compatible lenses, visit the Sony web site in your area, or consult your Sony dealer or local authorized Sony
service facility.
Related Topic
AF System (still image)
83
Help Guide
Focus Standard
If you assign [Focus Standard] to the desired custom key, you can recall useful functions such as focusing on a subject
in the center of the screen automatically in accordance with the focus area settings.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → desired key, then assign the [Focus Standard]
function to the key.
To use the [Focus Standard] function while shooting movies, select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [
Custom Key] → the desired button, and then assign [Focus Standard] to the key.
What you can do by pressing the key varies depending on the settings for [Focus Area] and [Center Lock-on
AF].
When [Focus Area] is set to [Zone], [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot]:
Pressing the key moves the focusing frame back to the center.
When [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Center]:
When [Center Lock-on AF] is set to [On], [Center Lock-on AF] is activated by pressing the key. The camera detects
the subject positioned in the center of the screen and starts tracking by pressing the center of the control wheel while
[Center Lock-on AF] is activated.
When [Center Lock-on AF] is set to [Off], the camera focuses on the center point.
Note
You cannot set the [Focus Standard] function to [Left Button], [Right Button] or [Down Button].
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Focus Area
Center Lock-on AF
84
Help Guide
Focus Settings
Configures the focus functions using the front dial/rear dial or the control wheel.
When the focus mode is set to auto focus or Direct Manual Focus
You can adjust the focus area settings and the position of the focusing frame. The focusing frame can be moved only
when the [Focus Area] is set to the following:
[Zone]
[Flexible Spot]
[Expand Flexible Spot]
85
Help Guide
You can set whether to switch the [Focus Area] and the position of the focusing frame according to the orientation of the
camera (horizontal/vertical). This function is useful when shooting scenes for which you have to change the camera
position frequently, such as portraits or sports scenes.
Three camera orientations are detected: horizontal, vertical with the side of the shutter button facing up, and vertical
with the side of the shutter button facing down.
Note
If the setting for [ Swt. V/H AF Area] is changed, the focus settings for each camera orientation will not be retained.
The [Focus Area] and the position of the focusing frame will not change even when [ Swt. V/H AF Area] is set to [AF Point +
AF Area] or [AF Point Only] in the following situations:
When the shooting mode is set to [Intelligent Auto], [Movie], or [S&Q Motion]
While the shutter button is pressed halfway down
During movie shooting
While using the digital zoom function
While the auto-focusing is activated
When [Focus Settings] are activated
During continuous shooting
During the countdown for the self-timer
When [Focus Magnifier] is activated
86
When you shoot images right after the power is turned on and the camera is vertical, the first shot is taken with the horizontal
focus setting or with the last focus setting.
The orientation of the camera cannot be detected when the lens is facing up or down.
Related Topic
Focus Area
87
Help Guide
AF/MF control
You can easily switch the focusing mode from auto to manual and vice versa while shooting without changing your
holding position.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key] → desired button → [AF/MF
Control Hold] or [AF/MF Ctrl Toggle].
Note
You cannot set the [AF/MF Control Hold] function to [Left Button], [Right Button] or [Down Button] of the control wheel.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
88
Help Guide
Selects whether to focus automatically when you press the shutter button halfway down. Select [Off] to adjust the focus
and the exposure separately.
Related Topic
AF On
Eye-Start AF (still image)
Pre-AF (still image)
Focus Magnifier
89
Help Guide
AF On
You can focus without pressing the shutter button halfway down. The settings for [Focus Mode] will be applied.
1 Press the AF-ON (AF On) button while shooting in autofocus mode.
Hint
Set [ AF w/ shutter] to [Off] when you do not want to perform auto focusing using the shutter button.
Set [ AF w/ shutter], [ Pre-AF], and [ Eye-Start AF] to [Off] to focus at a specific shooting distance predicting the
position of the subject.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
AF w/ shutter (still image)
Pre-AF (still image)
Eye-Start AF (still image)
90
Help Guide
Face/Eye AF Set.
This function is used to determine whether or not the camera will focus with priority on faces or eyes.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
91
[Eye AF] by custom key
The Eye AF function can also be used by assigning [Eye AF] to a custom key. The camera can focus on eyes as long as
you are pressing the key. This is useful when you want to temporarily apply the Eye AF function to the entire screen
regardless of the setting for [Focus Area].
For instance, if [Focus Area] is set to [Flexible Spot] and you want the camera to focus on an eye outside of the focusing
frame, you can apply the Eye AF function by pressing the custom key to which [Eye AF] has been assigned, without
changing [Focus Area].
1. MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → desired key, then assign the [Eye AF] function to the
key.
2. MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Face/Eye AF Set.] → [Subject Detection] → desired setting.
3. Point the camera at the face of a human or animal, and press the key to which you have assigned the [Eye AF]
function.
4. Press the shutter button while pressing the key.
Hint
If you want the face or eye detection frame to disappear within a certain period of time after the camera has focused on the face
or eye, set [AF Area Auto Clear] to [On].
To detect animal eyes, arrange the composition so that both eyes and the nose of the animal are within the angle of view.
Note
When [Subject Detection] is set to [Human], the eyes of animals are not detected. When [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal],
human faces are not detected.
When the shooting mode is set to [Portrait] under [Scene Selection], [Face/Eye Prty in AF] is locked to [On] and [Subject
Detection] is locked to [Human].
When [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal], the following functions are unavailable.
[Lock-on AF]
[Center Lock-on AF]
[Face Prty in Mlti Mtr]
[Regist. Faces Priority]
The [Eye AF] function may not function very well in the following situations:
When the person is wearing sunglasses.
When the front hair covers the person’s eyes.
In low-light or back-lit conditions.
When the eyes are closed.
When the subject is in the shade.
When the subject is out of focus.
When the subject is moving too much.
If the subject is moving too much, the detection frame may not be displayed correctly over their eyes.
When the camera cannot focus on human eyes, it will detect and focus on the face instead. The camera cannot focus on eyes
when no human faces are detected.
92
The product may not detect faces at all or may accidentally detect other objects as faces in some conditions.
The Eye AF function is unavailable when the mode dial is set to (Movie) or , or during movie shooting.
The eye detection frame is not displayed when the Eye AF function is unavailable.
You cannot use the face/eye detection function with the following functions:
Zoom functions other than the optical zoom.
[Posterization] under [Picture Effect]
Focus Magnifier
When [Scene Selection] is set to [Landscape], [Night Scene], or [Sunset]
When [ Frame Rate] is set to [120fps]/[100fps] during slow-motion/quick-motion shooting.
You cannot use the face detection function in the following situation:
Movie shooting with [ Record Setting] set to [120p]/[100p]
Even if [Face Dtct Frame Dsp] is set to [Off], a green focusing frame will be displayed over faces that are in focus.
When the shooting mode is set to [Intelligent Auto], [Face/Eye Prty in AF] is locked to [On].
Even when [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal], the eyes of some types of animals cannot be detected.
Even when [Animal Eye Display] is set to [Off], a green focusing frame is displayed over eyes that are in focus.
Related Topic
Focus Mode
Focus Area
AF Area Auto Clear
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Version
93
Help Guide
You can focus on the subject more accurately using auto-focus by magnifying the area where you want to focus. While
the magnified image is displayed, you can focus on a smaller area than the flexible spot.
3 Magnify the image by pressing the center of the multi-selector, and then adjust the position by pressing the
multi-selector up/down/left/right.
The magnification scale changes each time you press the center.
Hint
Use of a tripod is recommended to accurately identify the location you want to magnify.
You can check the auto-focusing result by magnifying the displayed image. If you want to readjust the focus position, adjust the
focus area on the magnified screen and then press the shutter button halfway down.
Note
If you enlarge an area at the edge of the screen, the camera may not be able to focus.
The exposure and white balance cannot be adjusted while the displayed image is being magnified.
While the displayed image is being magnified, the following functions are unavailable:
[Eye AF]
[Center Lock-on AF]
[ Eye-Start AF]
[ Pre-AF]
[Face/Eye Prty in AF]
94
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
95
Help Guide
Center Lock-on AF
When you press the center of the control wheel, the camera detects the subject positioned in the center of the screen
and continues to track the subject.
2 Align the target frame (A) over the subject and press the center of the control wheel.
Press the center again to stop tracking.
Hint
If you assign the [Focus Standard] function to the key of your choice, you can activate [Center Lock-on AF] or detect a subject
again by pressing the key when [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Center].
You can select the subject to be tracked by touch operation when shooting using the monitor. Set [Touch Operation] to [On], and
select [Touch Panel+Pad] or [Touch Panel Only] under [Touch Panel/Pad].
Note
The [Center Lock-on AF] function may not function very well in the following situations:
The subject is moving too quickly.
The subject is too small, or too large.
The contrast between the subject and the background is poor.
It is dark.
The ambient light changes.
Related Topic
96
Focus Standard
97
Help Guide
Focus Hold
Locks the focus while the key to which the Focus Hold function has been assigned is pressed.
1 MENU→ (Camera Settings2)→[ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key] →assign the [Focus Hold]
function to the key of your choice.
2 Focus and press the key to which the [Focus Hold] function has been assigned.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
98
Help Guide
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
You can move the focusing frame to a preassigned position temporarily using a custom key. This function is useful when
shooting scenes in which the subject’s movements are predictable; for example, sports scenes. With this function, you
can switch the focus area quickly according to the situation.
If you assign [Regist AF Area tggle] to a custom key, you can use the registered focusing frame without holding down the key.
If [Reg. AF Area+AF On] is assigned to a custom key, auto focusing using the registered focusing frame is performed when the
key is pressed.
Note
A focus area cannot be registered in the following situations:
The mode dial is set to either (Movie) or
While [Touch Focus] is being performed
While using the digital zoom function
While [Lock-on AF] is being performed
While focusing
While performing focus lock
You cannot assign [Regist. AF Area hold] to [Left Button], [Right Button], or [Down Button].
You cannot call up the registered focus area in the following situations:
The mode dial is set to either (Auto Mode), (Movie) or
When [ AF Area Regist.] is set to [On], the [Lock Operation Parts] setting is locked to [Off].
Related Topic
Focus Area
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
99
Help Guide
Deletes the focusing frame position that was registered using [ AF Area Regist.].
Related Topic
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
100
Help Guide
The product automatically adjusts focus before you press the shutter button halfway down. During focusing operations,
the screen may shake.
Note
[ Pre-AF] is available only when an E-mount lens is mounted.
101
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to use autofocus when you look through an Electronic Viewfinder.
Hint
[ Eye-Start AF] is available when an A-mount lens and a Mount Adaptor (LA-EA2, LA-EA4) (sold separately) are attached.
102
Help Guide
You can select the AF track sensitivity when the subject goes out of focus in still image mode.
103
Help Guide
Sets whether to release the shutter even if the subject is not in focus when [Focus Mode] is set to [Single-shot AF],
[DMF] or [Automatic AF] and the subject is remaining still.
Related Topic
Focus Mode
Priority Set in AF-C
104
Help Guide
Sets whether to release the shutter even if the subject is not in focus when the continuous AF is activated and the
subject is in motion.
Related Topic
Focus Mode
Priority Set in AF-S
105
Help Guide
The AF illuminator supplies fill light to focus more easily on a subject in dark surroundings. In the time between pressing
the shutter button halfway down and locking the focus, the red AF illuminator lights up to allow the camera to focus
easily.
Note
You cannot use [ AF Illuminator] in the following situations:
When the shooting mode is [Movie] or [S&Q Motion].
When [ Focus Mode] is set to [Continuous AF] or [Automatic AF] and the subject is moving (when the focus indicator or
lights up).
When [Focus Magnifier] is activated.
When [Scene Selection] is set to the following modes:
[Landscape]
[Sports Action]
[Night Scene]
If the Multi Interface Shoe is equipped with a flash with an AF illuminator function, when the flash is turned on, the AF illuminator
will turn on as well.
The AF illuminator emits a very bright light. Although there is no health hazard, do not look directly into the AF illuminator at close
range.
106
Help Guide
Sets whether the focus area should be displayed all the time or should disappear automatically shortly after focus is
achieved.
107
Help Guide
You can set whether or not to display the area that is in focus when [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Zone], in
[Continuous AF] mode.
Note
When [Focus Area] is set to one of the following, the focusing frames in the area that is in focus turn green:
[Center]
[Flexible Spot]
[Expand Flexible Spot]
When an A-mount lens and a Mount Adaptor (LA-EA1/LA-EA3) (sold separately) are mounted on the camera and [ AF
System] is set to [Phase Detection AF], [Disp. cont. AF area] is always turned on regardless of the [Focus Area] settings.
108
Help Guide
AF Micro Adj.
Allows you to adjust the auto-focusing position and register an adjusted value for each lens when using A-mount lenses
with an LA-EA2 or LA-EA4 Mount Adaptor (sold separately).
Use this function only when adjustments are needed. Note that the auto focus function may not be performed at a proper
position when using this adjustment.
Hint
It is recommended that you adjust the position under actual shooting conditions. Set [Focus Area] to [Flexible Spot] and use a
bright subject with high contrast when you adjust.
Note
When you attach a lens for which you have already registered a value, the registered value appears on the screen. [±0] appears
for lenses for which a value has not yet been registered.
If [-] is displayed as the value, then a total of 30 lenses have been registered and no new lens can be registered. To register a
new lens, attach a lens for which the registration can be erased, and set its value to [±0], or reset the values of all the lenses
using [Clear].
The [AF Micro Adj.] supports Sony, Minolta, or Konica-Minolta lenses. If you perform [AF Micro Adj.] with lenses other than the
supported lenses, the registered settings for the supported lenses may be affected. Do not perform [AF Micro Adj.] with an
unsupported lens.
You cannot set [AF Micro Adj.] individually for a Sony, Minolta, and Konica-Minolta lens of the same specification.
109
Help Guide
Sets the focus detection system (Phase Detection AF/Contrast AF) when you attach an A-mount lens using an LA-
EA1/LA-EA3 Mount Adaptor (sold separately).
Note
When [ AF System] is set to [Contrast AF], [Continuous AF] under [Focus Mode] is unavailable.
The following functions are unavailable when [ AF System] is set to [Phase Detection AF]:
[Zone], [Expand Flexible Spot], and [Lock-on AF] in [Focus Area] (All types of focus area are available when the camera's
system software (firmware) version is 2.00 or later.)
[Center Lock-on AF]
When [ AF System] is set to [Phase Detection AF], [Priority Set in AF-S] will temporarily switch to [AF] even if it is set to
[Balanced Emphasis].
110
Help Guide
You can reduce the sound from the aperture drive when shooting using a compatible lens.
This function can be used when the camera's system software (firmware) is Ver. 2.00 or later.
Note
When [Silent Priority] is selected, the focusing speed may become slower, and it may be more difficult to focus on a subject.
[Aperture Drive in AF] is unavailable when using a lens incompatible with this function.
Related Topic
Version
111
Help Guide
Manual Focus
When it is difficult to focus properly in the autofocus mode, you can adjust the focus manually.
When you rotate the focusing ring, the focus distance is displayed on the screen.
The focus distance is not displayed when the Mount Adaptor (sold separately) is attached.
Note
When you use the viewfinder, adjust the diopter level to obtain the correct focus on the viewfinder.
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
Peaking Setting
MF Assist (still image)
112
Help Guide
You can make fine adjustments manually after performing auto focusing, letting you focus on a subject more quickly than
when using the manual focus from the beginning. This is convenient in situations such as macro shooting.
3 Keep the shutter button pressed halfway down, and then rotate the focusing ring to achieve a sharper
focus.
When you rotate the focusing ring, the focus distance is displayed on the screen.
The focus distance is not displayed when the Mount Adaptor (sold separately) is attached.
Related Topic
Peaking Setting
113
Help Guide
Focus Magnifier
You can check the focus by enlarging the image before shooting.
Unlike with [ MF Assist], you can magnify the image without operating the focus ring.
2 Press the center of the multi-selector to enlarge the image and select the area you want to enlarge by
pressing the multi-selector up/down/left/right.
Each time you press the center, the magnification scale will change.
You can set the initial magnification by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Initial Focus
Mag.].
Press the (Delete) button to bring the magnified position into the center of an image.
When the focus mode is [Manual Focus], you can adjust the focus while an image is magnified. If [ AF in
Focus Mag.] is set to [Off], the [Focus Magnifier] function is canceled when the shutter button is pressed
halfway down.
When the shutter button is pressed halfway down while an image is magnified during the auto-focusing,
different functions are performed depending on the [ AF in Focus Mag.] setting.
You can set how long the image is to be shown magnified by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) →
[Focus Magnif. Time].
Hint
While using the focus magnifier function, you can move the magnified area by dragging it on the touch panel.
To exit the focus magnifier function, double-tap the monitor again. When [ AF in Focus Mag.] is set to [Off], the focus
magnifier function is ended by pressing the shutter button halfway down.
Related Topic
MF Assist (still image)
Focus Magnif. Time
114
Initial Focus Mag. (still image)
AF in Focus Mag. (still image)
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Touch Operation
115
Help Guide
Enlarges the image on the screen automatically to make manual focusing easier. This works in Manual Focus or Direct
Manual Focus shooting.
Hint
You can set how long the image is to be shown magnified by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Focus Magnif.
Time].
Note
You cannot use [ MF Assist] when shooting movies. Use the [Focus Magnifier] function instead.
[ MF Assist] is not available when a Mount Adaptor is attached. Use the [Focus Magnifier] function instead.
Related Topic
Manual Focus
Direct manual focus (DMF)
Focus Magnif. Time
116
Help Guide
Set the duration for which an image is to be magnified using the [ MF Assist] or [Focus Magnifier] function.
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
MF Assist (still image)
117
Help Guide
Sets the initial magnification scale when using [Focus Magnifier]. Select a setting that will help you frame your shot.
x1.0:
Displays the image with the same magnification as the shooting screen.
x5.9:
Displays a 5.9-times enlarged image.
x1.0:
Displays the image with the same magnification as the shooting screen.
x3.8:
Displays a 3.8-times enlarged image.
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
118
Help Guide
Peaking Setting
Sets the peaking function, which enhances the outline of in-focus areas during shooting with Manual Focus or Direct
Manual Focus.
Note
Since the product recognizes sharp areas as in focus, the effect of peaking differs, depending on the subject and lens.
The outline of in-focus ranges is not enhanced on devices connected via HDMI.
Related Topic
Manual Focus
Direct manual focus (DMF)
119
Help Guide
Drive Mode
Select the appropriate mode for the subject, such as single shooting, continuous shooting or bracketing shooting.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Note
When the shooting mode is set to [Scene Selection] and [Sports Action] is selected, [Single Shooting] cannot be performed.
Related Topic
Cont. Shooting
Self-timer
Self-timer(Cont)
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
WB bracket
DRO Bracket
120
121
Help Guide
Cont. Shooting
Shoots images continuously while you press and hold down the shutter button.
You can also set the continuous shooting by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Hint
To continuously adjust the focus and exposure during continuous shooting, set as follows:
[Focus Mode]: [Continuous AF]
[ AEL w/ shutter]: [Off] or [Auto]
Note
The shooting speed during continuous shooting becomes slower when [ RAW File Type] is set to [Uncompressed].
The shooting speed during continuous shooting becomes slower when [e-Front Curtain Shut.] is set to [Off] in [Continuous
Shooting: Hi], [Continuous Shooting: Mid] or [Continuous Shooting: Lo] mode.
122
When the F-value is greater than F11 in [Continuous Shooting: Hi+], [Continuous Shooting: Hi] or [Continuous Shooting: Mid]
mode, the focus is locked to the setting in the first shot.
The subject is not displayed in real-time on the monitor or viewfinder when shooting in [Continuous Shooting: Hi+] mode.
Related Topic
Displaying continuous shooting remaining time indicator (Cont. Shoot. Length)
Focus Mode
AEL w/ shutter (still image)
123
Help Guide
Sets whether to display an indicator of the remaining time for which continuous shooting can be performed at the same
shooting speed.
Hint
When the internal camera memory for buffering is full, “SLOW” will be displayed and the continuous shooting speed will
decrease.
Related Topic
Cont. Shooting
124
Help Guide
Self-timer
Shoots an image using the self-timer after a designated number of seconds have elapsed since the shutter button was
pressed. Use the 5-second/10-second self-timer when you are going to be in the picture, and use the 2-second self-timer
to reduce camera-shake caused by pressing the shutter button.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
The self-timer lamp flashes, a beep sounds, and a picture is taken after the designated number of seconds have
elapsed.
Self-timer: 10 Sec
Self-timer: 5 Sec
Self-timer: 2 Sec
Hint
Press the shutter button again or press / on the control wheel to stop the count of the self-timer.
Press / on the control wheel and select (Single Shooting) to cancel the self-timer.
Set [Audio signals] to [Off] to mute the beep sound during self-timer counting.
To use the self-timer in bracket mode, select bracket mode under drive mode, then select MENU → (Camera Settings1) →
[Bracket Settings] → [Selftimer during Brkt].
Note
The self-timer is unavailable in the following situations:
[Sports Action] under [Scene Selection]
Related Topic
Audio signals
125
Help Guide
Self-timer(Cont)
Shoots a designated number of images using the self-timer after a designated number of seconds have elapsed since
the shutter button was pressed. You can choose the best from multiple shots.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
The self-timer lamp flashes, a beep sounds, and pictures are taken after the designated number of seconds has
elapsed. The designated number of pictures are taken continuously.
Hint
Press the shutter button again or press / on the control wheel to stop the count of the self-timer.
Press / on the control wheel and select (Single Shooting) to cancel the self-timer.
126
Help Guide
Cont. Bracket
Shoots multiple images while automatically shifting the exposure from base to darker and then to lighter. You can select
an image that suits your purpose after recording.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Note
The last shot is shown on the auto review.
When [ISO AUTO] is selected in [Manual Exposure] mode, the exposure is changed by adjusting the ISO value. If a setting other
than [ISO AUTO] is selected, the exposure is changed by adjusting the shutter speed.
When the exposure is compensated, the exposure is shifted based on the compensated value.
When the flash is used, the product performs flash bracket shooting, which shifts the amount of flash light even if [Cont. Bracket]
is selected. Press the shutter button for each image.
Related Topic
Bracket Settings
Indicator during bracket shooting
127
Help Guide
Single Bracket
Shoots multiple images while automatically shifting the exposure from base to darker and then to lighter. You can select
the image that suits your purpose after recording.
Since a single picture is taken each time you press the shutter button, you can adjust the focus or the composition for
each shot.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Note
When [ISO AUTO] is selected in [Manual Exposure] mode, the exposure is changed by adjusting the ISO value. If a setting other
than [ISO AUTO] is selected, the exposure is changed by adjusting the shutter speed.
When the exposure is compensated, the exposure is shifted based on the compensated value.
Related Topic
Bracket Settings
Indicator during bracket shooting
128
Help Guide
Viewfinder
Ambient light* bracketing
3 images shifted by 0.3 EV steps
Exposure compensation ±0.0 EV
Flash bracketing
3 images shifted by 0.7 EV steps
Flash compensation -1.0 EV
* Ambient light: A generic term for non-flash light including natural light, electric bulb and fluorescent lighting. Whereas the flash light blinks for a
moment, ambient light is constant, so this kind of light is called "ambient light."
Note
During bracket shooting, guides equal to the number of images to be shot are displayed over/under the bracket indicator.
When you start single bracket shooting, the guides will disappear one by one as the camera records images.
129
130
Help Guide
WB bracket
Shoots a total of three images, each with different color tones according to the selected settings for white balance, color
temperature and color filter.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Note
The last shot is shown on the auto review.
Related Topic
Bracket Settings
131
Help Guide
DRO Bracket
You can record a total of three images, each at a different degree of D-Range Optimizer value.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Note
The last shot is shown on the auto review.
Related Topic
Bracket Settings
132
Help Guide
Bracket Settings
You can set the self-timer in bracket shooting mode, and the shooting order for exposure bracketing and white balance
bracketing.
1 Select / (Drive Mode) of the control wheel → select bracket shooting mode.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
Related Topic
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
WB bracket
DRO Bracket
133
Help Guide
You can automatically shoot a series of still images with the shooting interval and number of shots that you set in
advance (Interval shooting). You can then create a movie from the still images produced by interval shooting using the
computer software Imaging Edge. You cannot create a movie from the still images on the camera.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
2 MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Intvl. Shoot. Func.] → Select the item you want to set and the
desired setting.
When the time set for [Shooting Start Time] has elapsed, shooting will start.
When the number of shots set for [Number of Shots] is completed, the camera will return to the standby screen
for interval shooting.
Hint
If you press the shutter button during interval shooting, interval shooting will end and the camera will return to the standby screen
for interval shooting.
To go back to the normal shooting mode, select MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Intvl. Shoot. Func.] → [Interval
Shooting] → [Off].
If you press a key to which one of the following functions has been assigned at the moment when shooting starts, the function will
remain active during interval shooting even without you holding down the button.
[AEL hold]
[ AEL hold]
134
[AF/MF Control Hold]
[Regist. AF Area hold]
Still images shot with interval shooting are displayed as a group on the playback screen.
Still images shot with interval shooting can be played back continuously on the camera. If you intend to create a movie using the
still images, you can preview the result.
Note
You may not be able to record the set number of images depending on the remaining battery level and the amount of free space
on the recording medium. Supply power via USB while shooting, and use a memory card with sufficient space.
During interval shooting (including the time between pressing the shutter button and the start of shooting), you cannot perform
MENU operations, but you can perform dial operations. You can perform MENU operations until you press the shutter button.
[Silent Shoot. in Intvl.] is set to [On] in the default settings, regardless of the setting for [ Silent Shooting].
Related Topic
Imaging Edge
Version
135
Help Guide
Touch Operation
Related Topic
Touch Focus
Touch Pad Settings
Touch Panel/Pad
136
Help Guide
Touch Panel/Pad
Touch operations when shooting with the monitor are referred to as "touch panel operations," and touch operations when
shooting with the viewfinder are referred to as "touch pad operations." You can select whether to activate touch panel
operations or touch pad operations.
Related Topic
Touch Operation
137
Help Guide
Touch Focus
You can select a subject on which to focus using touch operations in the still image and movie recording modes.
Specifying the position where you want to focus in the still image mode
You can focus on the desired position by touching the monitor.
1. Select a [Focus Area] other than [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot].
2. MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Center Lock-on AF] → [Off].
3. Touch the monitor.
When shooting with the monitor, touch the subject to focus.
When shooting with the viewfinder, you can move the position of the focus by touching and dragging on the
monitor while looking through the viewfinder.
When the shutter button is pressed halfway down, the camera focuses on the focusing frame. Press the shutter
button all the way down to shoot images.
To cancel focusing with touch operations, touch or press the center of the control wheel if shooting with the
monitor, and press the center of the control wheel if shooting with the viewfinder.
Specifying the position where you want to focus in the movie recording mode (spot focus)
The camera will focus on the touched subject. Spot focus is not available when shooting with the viewfinder.
1. Select a [Focus Area] other than [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot].
2. MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Center Lock-on AF] → [Off].
3. Touch the subject on which you want to focus before or during recording.
When you touch the subject, the focus mode temporarily switches to manual focus and the focus can be adjusted
using the focus ring.
To cancel spot focus, touch or press the center of the control wheel.
Hint
In addition to the touch focus function, touch operations such as the following are also available.
When [Focus Area] is set to [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot], the focusing frame can be moved using touch
operations.
When the [Focus Mode] is set to [Manual Focus], the focus magnifier can be used by double-tapping the monitor.
Note
138
The touch focus function is not available in the following situations:
When [Focus Mode] is set to [Manual Focus].
When using the digital zoom
When using the LA-EA2 or LA-EA4
When using the LA-EA1 or LA-EA3, and the shooting mode is set to Movie
Related Topic
Touch Operation
Touch Panel/Pad
139
Help Guide
You can adjust settings related to touch pad operations during viewfinder shooting.
Selecting [Relative Position] lets you operate the touch pad from wherever is easiest, without having to move your finger
over a wide area.
Hint
In touch pad operations when [Touch Pos. Mode] is set to [Absolute Position], the area set in [Operation Area] is treated as the
entire screen.
140
Related Topic
Touch Operation
141
Help Guide
The larger the image size, the more detail will be reproduced when the image is printed on large-format paper. The
smaller the image size, the more images can be recorded.
Note
When [ File Format] is set to [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG], the image size for RAW images corresponds to “L.”
Related Topic
142
Aspect Ratio (still image)
143
Help Guide
Selects the JPEG image quality when [ File Format] is set to [RAW & JPEG] or [JPEG].
Related Topic
File Format (still image)
144
Help Guide
145
Help Guide
You can set whether RAW images are compressed or uncompressed using [ RAW File Type].
Note
If you do not intend to edit the images on your computer, we recommend that you record in JPEG format.
You cannot add DPOF (print order) registration marks to RAW images.
Related Topic
JPEG Image Size (still image)
RAW File Type (still image)
146
Help Guide
Note
When [Uncompressed] is selected for [ RAW File Type], the icon on the screen switches to . is also displayed
while an image shot in uncompressed RAW format is played back.
147
Help Guide
APS-C/Super 35mm
Sets whether to record in APS-C-equivalent size for still images and in Super 35mm-equivalent size for movies. You can
use an APS-C-size dedicated lens with this product by recording in an APS-C-equivalent size or Super 35 mm-
equivalent size.
Note
If you try to perform full-frame shooting with an APS-C-compatible lens attached, you may not achieve the desired shooting
results.
When APS-C/Super 35 mm shooting is activated, the central part of the image sensor is used and the angle of view is equivalent
to that of an APS-C-size image sensor.
148
Help Guide
Angle of view
The angle of view switches to the equivalent of full frame or APS-C/Super 35mm, depending on the setting for [APS-
C/Super 35mm] and the attached lens. The angle of view is also different for still image shooting and movie shooting.
(A) When shooting still images (with [ Aspect Ratio] set to [3:2])
(B) When recording movies
The camera shoots with an angle of view equivalent to full frame in the following situations.
[ Shooting] under [APS-C/Super 35mm] is set to [Auto], and a full frame shooting-compatible lens is attached.
[ Shooting] under [APS-C/Super 35mm] is set to [Manual], and [ Shoot.: Manual] is set to [Off].
(A) When shooting still images (with [ Aspect Ratio] set to [3:2])
(B) When recording movies
The camera shoots with an angle of view equivalent to APS-C size or Super 35mm in the following situations. The angle
of view becomes approx. 1.5 times the focal length indicated on the lens.
[ Shooting] under [APS-C/Super 35mm] is set to [Auto], and an APS-C-format dedicated lens is attached.
[ Shooting] under [APS-C/Super 35mm] is set to [Manual], and [ Shoot.: Manual] is set to [On].
Note
When recording full-frame movies with [ File Format] set to [XAVC S 4K] and [ Record Setting] set to [30p 60M] or [30p
100M], the angle of view (B) is equivalent to approx. 1.2 times the focal length indicated on the lens.
149
(A) Angle of view equivalent to full-frame
(B) Angle of view during XAVC S 4K movie recording set to [30p 60M]/[30p 100M]
(C) Angle of view equivalent to Super 35mm
Related Topic
File Format (movie)
Record Setting (movie)
APS-C/Super 35mm
150
Help Guide
You can switch the shooting mode according to the subject or purpose of shooting.
Available functions
(Intelligent Auto):
Allows you to shoot with automatic scene recognition.
P (Program Auto):
Allows you to shoot with the exposure adjusted automatically (both the shutter speed and the aperture value (F value)).
Also you can select various settings using the menu.
A (Aperture Priority):
Allows you to adjust the aperture and shoot when you want to blur the background, etc.
S (Shutter Priority):
Allows you to shoot fast-moving subjects etc., by manually adjusting the shutter speed.
M (Manual Exposure):
Allows you to shoot still images with the desired exposure by adjusting the exposure (both the shutter speed and the
aperture value (F value)).
1/2(Memory recall):
Allows you to shoot an image after recalling often-used modes or numeric settings registered in advance.
(Movie):
Allows you to change the exposure mode for movie recording.
(S&Q Motion):
Allows you to shoot slow-motion and quick-motion movies.
SCN (Scene Selection):
Allows you to shoot with preset settings according to the scene.
Related Topic
Intelligent Auto
Program Auto
Aperture Priority
Shutter Priority
Manual Exposure
Recall (Camera Settings1/Camera Settings2)
Movie: Exposure Mode
151
S&Q Motion: Exposure Mode
Scene Selection
152
Help Guide
Intelligent Auto
When the camera recognized the scene, the icon for the recognized scene appears on the screen.
Note
The product will not recognize the scene when you shoot images with zoom functions other than optical zoom.
The product may not properly recognize the scene under certain shooting conditions.
For [Intelligent Auto] mode, most of the functions are set automatically, and you cannot adjust the settings on your own.
Related Topic
About Scene Recognition
Face/Eye AF Set.
Face Prty in Mlti Mtr
153
Help Guide
This function allows the product to automatically recognize the shooting conditions and shoot the image.
Scene Recognition
When the product recognizes certain scenes, the following icons and guides are displayed on the first line:
(Portrait)
(Infant)
(Night Portrait)
(Night Scene)
(Backlight Portrait)
(Backlight)
(Landscape)
(Macro)
(Spotlight)
(Low Light)
(Night Scene using a tripod)
Related Topic
Intelligent Auto
154
Help Guide
Program Auto
Allows you to shoot with the exposure adjusted automatically (both the shutter speed and the aperture value).
Program Shift
When you are not using a flash, you can change the shutter speed and aperture (F-value) combination without changing
the appropriate exposure set by the camera.
Turn the front/rear dial to select the aperture value and shutter speed combination.
“P” on the screen changes to “P*” when you turn the front/rear dial.
To cancel program shift, set the shooting mode to other than [Program Auto], or turn off the camera.
Note
According to the brightness of the environment, the program shift may not be used.
Set the shooting mode to another one than “P” or turn off the power to cancel the setting you made.
When the brightness changes, the aperture (F-value) and shutter speed also change while maintaining the shift amount.
155
Help Guide
Aperture Priority
You can shoot by adjusting the aperture and changing the range in focus, or by defocusing the background.
Smaller F-value: The subject is in focus, but objects in front of and beyond the subject are blurred.
Larger F-value: The subject and its foreground and background are all in focus.
If the aperture value you have set is not suitable for appropriate exposure, the shutter speed on the shooting
screen will blink. If this happens, change the aperture value.
Note
The brightness of the image on the screen may differ from the actual image being shot.
Related Topic
Aperture Preview
156
Help Guide
Shutter Priority
You can express the movement of a moving subject in various ways by adjusting the shutter speed, for example, at the
instant of the movement with high speed shutter, or as a trailing image with low speed shutter.
If proper exposure cannot be obtained after setup, the aperture value on the shooting screen blinks. If this
happens, change the shutter speed.
Hint
Use a tripod to prevent camera-shake when you have selected a slow shutter speed.
When you shoot indoor sports scenes, set the ISO sensitivity to a higher value.
Note
The SteadyShot warning indicator does not appear in shutter speed priority mode.
When [ Long Exposure NR] is set to [On] and the shutter speed is 1 second(s) or longer, noise reduction will be done after
shooting for the same amount of time that the shutter was open. However, you cannot shoot any more while noise reduction is in
progress.
The brightness of the image on the screen may differ from the actual image being shot.
Related Topic
Long Exposure NR (still image)
157
Help Guide
Manual Exposure
You can shoot with the desired exposure setting by adjusting both the shutter speed and aperture.
You can change the setting of the front/rear dial using MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Dial Setup].
You can also set [ISO] to [ISO AUTO] in manual exposure mode. The ISO value automatically changes to
achieve the appropriate exposure using the aperture value and shutter speed you have set.
When [ISO] is set to [ISO AUTO], the ISO value indicator will blink if the value you have set is not suitable for
appropriate exposure. If this happens, change the shutter speed or aperture value.
When [ISO] is set to other than [ISO AUTO], use MM (Metered Manual)* to check the exposure value.
Toward +: Images become brighter.
Toward -: Images become darker.
0: Appropriate exposure analyzed by the product.
* Indicates under/over for appropriate exposure. It is displayed using a numerical value on the monitor and with a metering indicator on
the viewfinder.
Hint
You can change the shutter speed and aperture (F-value) combination without changing the set exposure value by rotating the
front/rear dial while pressing the AEL button. (Manual shift)
Note
The Metered Manual indicator does not appear when [ISO] is set to [ISO AUTO].
When the amount of ambient light exceeds the metering range of the Metered Manual, the Metered Manual indicator flashes.
The SteadyShot warning indicator does not appear in manual exposure mode.
The brightness of the image on the screen may differ from the actual image being shot.
158
Help Guide
Bulb shooting
You can shoot a trailing image of the movement of a subject with long exposure.
Bulb shooting is suitable for shooting trails from stars or fireworks, etc.
5 Press and hold the shutter button for the duration of the shooting.
Hint
When shooting fireworks, etc., focus at infinity in manual focus mode. If you use a lens whose infinity point is unclear, adjust the
focus on the fireworks in the area you want to focus on in advance.
In order to perform bulb shooting without causing the image quality to deteriorate, we recommend that you start shooting while
the camera is cool.
Images shot in [BULB] mode tend to be blurry. We recommend that you use a tripod and a remote commander (sold separately)
that has a shutter button lock function. Use a remote commander supporting connection via multi/micro USB jack.
Note
The longer the exposure time, the more noise will be visible on the image.
After shooting, noise reduction will be done for the same amount of time that the shutter was open. However, you cannot shoot
any more while noise reduction is in progress.
You cannot set the shutter speed to [BULB] in the following situations:
[Auto HDR]
[Picture Effect] is set to [Rich-tone Mono.].
When [Drive Mode] is set to the following:
[Cont. Shooting]
[Self-timer(Cont)]
[Cont. Bracket]
[ Silent Shooting]
If you use the above functions when the shutter speed is set to [BULB], the shutter speed is temporarily set to 30 seconds.
Related Topic
Manual Exposure
159
4-732-947-15(1) Copyright 2018 Sony Corporation
160
Help Guide
Scene Selection
Sports Action:
Shoots a moving subject at a fast shutter speed so that the subject looks as if it is standing still. The product shoots
images continuously while the shutter button is pressed.
Macro:
Shoots close-ups of the subjects, such as flowers, insects, food, or small items.
Landscape:
Shoots the entire range of a scenery in sharp focus with vivid colors.
Sunset:
Shoots the red of the sunset beautifully.
161
Night Scene:
Shoots night scenes without losing the dark atmosphere.
Night Portrait:
Shoots night scene portraits using the flash (sold separately).
Hint
To change the scene, rotate the front dial on the shooting screen and select a new scene.
Note
Under the following settings, the shutter speed is slower, so use of a tripod, etc. is recommended to prevent the image from
blurring:
[Night Scene]
[Night Portrait]
The minimum distance that you can come close to a subject does not change even if you select [Macro]. For the minimum in-
focus range, refer to the minimum distance of the lens attached to the product.
Related Topic
Using flash (sold separately)
162
Help Guide
Allows you to shoot an image after recalling often-used modes or camera settings registered with [ /
Memory] in advance.
Hint
To recall settings registered to the memory card, set the mode dial to 1, 2 (Memory recall), then select the desired number by
pressing the left/right side of the control wheel.
If you recall settings registered to the memory card, the settings are recalled from the memory card in the slot specified in [
Select Media]. You can confirm the memory card slot by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Select Media].
Settings registered to a memory card using another camera of the same model name can be recalled with this camera.
Note
If you set [ / Recall] after completing the shooting settings, the registered settings are given priority and the
original settings may become invalid. Check the indicators on the screen before shooting.
Related Topic
Memory (Camera Settings1/Camera Settings2)
163
Help Guide
164
Help Guide
You can select the exposure mode for slow-motion/quick-motion shooting. You can change the setting and playback
speed for slow-motion/quick-motion shooting with [ S&Q Settings].
Related Topic
S&Q Settings
165
Help Guide
Exposure Comp.
Normally, exposure is set automatically (auto exposure). Based on the exposure value set by auto exposure, you can
make the entire image brighter or darker if you adjust [Exposure Comp.] to the plus side or minus side, respectively
(exposure compensation).
+ (over) side:
Images become brighter.
- (under) side:
Images become darker.
You can adjust the exposure compensation value within the range of -3.0 EV to +3.0 EV.
You can confirm the exposure compensation value that you set on the shooting screen.
Monitor
Viewfinder
166
To set the exposure compensation value using the MENU
You can adjust the exposure compensation value within a range of -5.0 EV to +5.0 EV when the exposure compensation
dial is set to “0.”
MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Exposure Comp.] → desired setting.
Note
You cannot perform the exposure compensation in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
When using [Manual Exposure], you can perform the exposure compensation only when [ISO] is set to [ISO AUTO].
The settings of the exposure compensation dial will be prioritized over [Exposure Comp.] or [Dial Ev Comp] in MENU.
Only a value between -3.0 EV and +3.0 EV with the equivalent image brightness appears on the screen when shooting. If you set
an exposure compensation value outside this range, the image brightness on the screen will not be affected, but the value will be
reflected in the recorded image.
You can adjust the exposure compensation value within the range of -2.0 EV to +2.0 EV for movies.
If you shoot a subject in extremely bright or dark conditions, or when you use the flash, you may not be able to get a satisfactory
effect.
When you set the exposure compensation dial to “0” from a setting other than “0,” the exposure value switches to “0” regardless
of the [Exposure Comp.] setting.
Related Topic
Exposure step
Dial Ev Comp
Exp.comp.set
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
Zebra Setting
167
Help Guide
Reset EV Comp.
Sets whether to maintain the exposure value set using [Exposure Comp.] when you turn off the power when the
exposure compensation dial position is set to “0.”
168
Help Guide
Dial Ev Comp
You can adjust the exposure using the front dial or rear dial when the exposure compensation dial is set to “0.” You can
adjust the exposure in a range of -5.0 EV to +5.0 EV.
Note
When the exposure compensation function is assigned to the front or rear dial, any function that had been assigned to that dial
previously is re-assigned to another dial.
The settings of the exposure compensation dial will be prioritized over [Exposure Comp.] in MENU or the exposure settings using
the front or rear dial.
Related Topic
Exposure Comp.
169
Help Guide
You can set whether to display a guide when you change the exposure.
170
Help Guide
Exposure step
You can adjust the setting increment for the shutter speed, aperture, and exposure compensation values.
171
Help Guide
Metering Mode
Selects the metering mode that sets which part of the screen to measure for determining the exposure.
Hint
When [Spot] is selected and [Focus Area] is set to either [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot] while [Spot Metering Point] is
set to [Focus Point Link], the spot metering point can be coordinated with the focus area.
When [Multi] is selected and [Face Prty in Mlti Mtr] is set to [On], the camera measures brightness based on detected faces.
When [Metering Mode] is set to [Highlight] and the [D-Range Opt.] or [Auto HDR] function is activated, the brightness and the
contrast will be corrected automatically by dividing the image into small areas and analyzing the contrast of light and shadow.
Make settings based on the shooting circumstances.
Note
[Metering Mode] is locked to [Multi] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
Other zoom functions than the optical zoom
In [Highlight] mode, the subject may be dark if a brighter part exists on the screen.
Related Topic
AE lock
Spot Metering Point
Face Prty in Mlti Mtr
D-Range Opt. (DRO)
172
Auto HDR
173
Help Guide
Sets whether the camera measures brightness based on detected faces when [Metering Mode] is set to [Multi].
Note
When the shooting mode is set to [Intelligent Auto], [Face Prty in Mlti Mtr] is locked to [On].
When [Face/Eye Prty in AF] is set to [On] and [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal] under [Face/Eye AF Set.], [Face Prty in Mlti
Mtr] does not work.
Related Topic
Metering Mode
174
Help Guide
Sets whether to coordinate the spot metering position with the focus area when [Focus Area] is set to [Flexible Spot] or
[Expand Flexible Spot].
Note
When [Focus Area] is set to other than [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot], the spot metering position is locked to the
center.
When [Focus Area] is set to [Lock-on AF: Flexible Spot] or [Lock-on AF:Expand Flexible Spot], the spot metering position
coordinates to the Lock-on AF start position, but does not coordinate with the tracking of the subject.
Related Topic
Focus Area
Metering Mode
175
Help Guide
AE lock
When the contrast between the subject and background is high, such as when shooting a backlit subject or a subject
near a window, meter the light at a spot where the subject appears to have the appropriate brightness and lock the
exposure before shooting. To reduce the brightness of the subject, meter the light at a spot brighter than the subject and
lock the exposure of the entire screen. To make the subject brighter, meter the light at a spot darker than the subject and
lock the exposure of the entire screen.
3 Keep pressing the AEL button and focus on the subject again, then shoot the picture.
Keep holding the AEL button down while taking a shot if you want to continue shooting with the fixed exposure.
Release the button to reset the exposure.
Hint
If you select the MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key] → [AEL Button] → [AEL toggle],
you can lock the exposure without holding down the button.
Note
[ AEL hold] and [ AEL toggle] are not available when using zoom functions other than optical zoom.
176
Help Guide
Sets whether to fix the exposure when you press the shutter button halfway down.
Select [Off] to adjust the focus and the exposure separately.
Note
Operation using the AEL button is prioritized over the [ AEL w/ shutter] settings.
177
Help Guide
Adjusts this camera's standard for the correct exposure value for each metering mode.
Metering Mode
The set standard value will be applied when you select the corresponding metering mode in MENU → (Camera
Settings1) → [Metering Mode].
Multi/ Center/ Spot/ Entire Screen Avg./ Highlight
Note
The exposure compensation will not be affected when [Exposure Std. Adjust] is changed.
The exposure value will be locked according to the value set for [ Spot] during using spot AEL.
The standard value for M.M (Metered Manual) will be changed according to the value set in [Exposure Std. Adjust].
The value set in [Exposure Std. Adjust] is recorded in Exif data separately from the exposure compensation value. The amount of
exposure standard value will not be added to the exposure compensation value.
If you set [Exposure Std. Adjust] during bracketing shooting, the number of shots for the bracketing will be reset.
Related Topic
Metering Mode
178
Help Guide
Exp.comp.set
Sets whether to apply the exposure compensation value to control both flash light and ambient light, or just ambient light.
Related Topic
Flash Comp.
179
Help Guide
Zebra Setting
Sets a zebra pattern, which appears over part of an image if the brightness level of that part meets the IRE level that you
have set. Use this zebra pattern as a guide to adjust the brightness.
Hint
You can register values to check the correct exposure or overexposure as well as the brightness level for [Zebra Level]. The
settings for correct exposure confirmation and overexposure confirmation are registered to [Custom1] and [Custom2] respectively
in the default settings.
To check the correct exposure, set a standard value and the range for the brightness level. The zebra pattern will appear on
areas that fall within the range you set.
To check the overexposure, set a minimum value for the brightness level. The zebra pattern will appear over areas with a
brightness level equal to or higher than the value you set.
Note
The zebra pattern is not displayed on devices connected via HDMI.
180
Help Guide
By dividing the image into small areas, the product analyzes the contrast of light and shadow between the subject and
the background, and creates an image with the optimal brightness and gradation.
2 Select the desired setting using the left/right sides of the control wheel.
Note
In the following situations, [D-Range Opt.] is fixed to [Off]:
When [Picture Effect] is set to other than [Off]
When [Picture Profile] is set to other than [Off]
[DRO/Auto HDR] is fixed to [Off] when the following modes are selected in [Scene Selection].
[Sunset]
[Night Scene]
[Night Portrait]
The setting is fixed to [D-Range Optimizer: Auto] when [Scene Selection] modes other than the above modes are selected.
When shooting with [D-Range Opt.], the image may be noisy. Select the proper level by checking the recorded image, especially
when you enhance the effect.
181
Help Guide
Auto HDR
Shoots three images using different exposures and combines the images with correct exposure, the bright parts of an
underexposed image, and the dark parts of an overexposed image to create images with a greater range of gradation
(High Dynamic Range). One image with proper exposure and one overlaid image are recorded.
2 Select the desired setting using the left/right sides of the control wheel.
Hint
The shutter is released three times for one shot. Be careful about the following:
Use this function when the subject is motionless or does not flash light.
Do not change the composition before shooting.
Note
This function is not available when the [ File Format] is [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG].
You cannot start the next shot until the capture process is completed after you shoot.
You may not obtain the desired effect depending on the luminance difference of a subject and the shooting conditions.
When the contrast of the scene is low or when product shake or subject blur occurs, you may not obtain good HDR images.
will be displayed over the recorded image to inform you when the camera detects image blurring. Change the
composition or re-shoot the image carefully to avoid image blur, as needed.
182
Help Guide
ISO
Sensitivity to light is expressed by the ISO number (recommended exposure index). The larger the number, the higher
the sensitivity.
You can change the value by 1/3 EV steps by turning the front dial as well as by turning the control wheel. You
can change the value by 1 EV steps by turning the rear dial.
Hint
You can change the range of ISO sensitivity that is set automatically in [ISO AUTO] mode. Select [ISO AUTO] and press the right
side of the control wheel, and set the desired values for [ISO AUTO Maximum] and [ISO AUTO Minimum].
Note
[ISO AUTO] is selected when using the following functions:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
When the ISO sensitivity is set to a value lower than ISO 100, the range for recordable subject brightness (dynamic range) may
decrease.
The higher the ISO value, the more noise will appear on the images.
The available ISO settings will differ depending on whether you are shooting still images, shooting movies, or shooting slow-
motion/quick-motion movies.
When shooting movies, ISO values between 100 and 102400 are available. If the ISO value is set to a value larger than 102400,
the setting is automatically switched to 102400. When you finish recording the movie, the ISO value returns to the original setting.
When shooting movies, ISO values between 100 and 102400 are available. If the ISO value is set to a value smaller than 100,
the setting is automatically switched to 100. When you finish recording the movie, the ISO value returns to the original setting.
When you select [ISO AUTO] with the shooting mode set to [P], [A], [S] or [M], the ISO sensitivity will be automatically adjusted
within the set range.
183
Help Guide
If you select [ISO AUTO] when the shooting mode is P (Program Auto) or A (Aperture Priority), you can set the shutter
speed at which the ISO sensitivity starts changing.
This function is effective for shooting moving subjects. You can minimize subject blurring while also preventing camera
shake.
Hint
The difference in shutter speed at which ISO sensitivity starts to change between [Faster], [Fast], [Standard], [Slow], and [Slower]
is 1 EV.
Note
If the exposure is insufficient even when the ISO sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO Maximum] in [ISO AUTO], in order to shoot with
an appropriate exposure, the shutter speed will be slower than the speed set in [ISO AUTO Min. SS].
In the following situations, the shutter speed may not function as set:
When using the flash to shoot bright scenes. (The maximum shutter speed is limited to the flash-syncing speed of 1/250
second.)
When using the flash to shoot dark scenes with the [Flash Mode] set to [Fill-flash]. (The minimum shutter speed is limited to the
speed automatically determined by the camera.)
Related Topic
Program Auto
Aperture Priority
ISO
184
Help Guide
The zoom feature of the product provides a higher magnification zoom by combining various zoom features. The icon
displayed on the screen changes, according to the selected zoom feature.
Note
The default setting for the [Zoom Setting] is [Optical zoom only].
The default setting for the [ JPEG Image Size] is [L]. To use the smart zoom, change [ JPEG Image Size] to [M] or [S].
Zoom functions other than the optical zoom are not available when shooting in the following situations:
[ File Format] is set to [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG].
[ Record Setting] is set to [120p]/[100p].
During slow-motion/quick-motion shooting with the [ Frame Rate] set to [120fps]/[100fps]
When a power zoom lens is mounted, you cannot use [Zoom] under MENU. If you enlarge image past the optical zoom range,
the product automatically switches to another [Zoom] function than the optical zoom.
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, [Metering Mode] is fixed to [Multi].
When using a zoom function other than the optical zoom, the following functions are not available:
Face/Eye Prty in AF
Face Prty in Mlti Mtr
Lock-on AF
185
To use another zoom function than the optical zoom for movies, assign [Zoom] to the desired key using [ Custom Key].
Related Topic
Clear Image Zoom/Digital Zoom (Zoom)
Zoom Setting
About zoom scale
186
Help Guide
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, you can exceed the zoom range of the optical zoom.
2 When a power zoom lens is mounted, move the zoom lever or the zoom ring of the zoom lens to enlarge
subjects.
When you exceed the zoom range of the optical zoom, the camera automatically switches to another zoom than
the optical zoom.
3 When a lens other than a power zoom lens is mounted, select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Zoom]
→ desired value.
Related Topic
Zoom Setting
The zoom features available with this product
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
187
Help Guide
Zoom Setting
Note
Set [Optical zoom only] if you want to magnify images within the range in which image quality does not deteriorate.
Related Topic
The zoom features available with this product
About zoom scale
188
Help Guide
The zoom scale that is used in combination with the zoom of the lens changes according to the selected image size.
L - -
Full-frame Approx. 2×
S
APS-C Approx. 2×
Full-frame Approx. 2×
L
APS-C Approx. 2×
Full-frame Approx. 3×
On:ClearImage Zoom M
APS-C Approx. 2.6×
Full-frame Approx. 4×
S
APS-C Approx. 4×
Full-frame Approx. 4×
L
APS-C Approx. 4×
Full-frame Approx. 8×
S
APS-C Approx. 8×
Related Topic
Clear Image Zoom/Digital Zoom (Zoom)
The zoom features available with this product
Zoom Setting
JPEG Image Size (still image)
189
Help Guide
Assigns zoom in (T) or zoom out (W) functions to the zoom ring rotation direction. Available only with power zoom lenses
that support this function.
190
Help Guide
White Balance
Corrects the tone effect of the ambient light condition to record a neutral white subject in white. Use this function when
the color tones of the image did not come out as you expected, or when you want to change the color tones on purpose
for photographic expression.
Hint
You can display the fine adjustment screen and perform fine adjustments of the color tones as required by pressing the right side
of the control wheel.
If the color tones do not come out as you expected in the selected settings, perform [WB bracket] shooting.
Note
[White Balance] is fixed to [Auto] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
If you use a mercury lamp or a sodium lamp as a light source, the accurate white balance will not be obtained because of the
characteristics of the light. It is recommended to shoot images using a flash or select [Custom Setup].
Related Topic
Capturing a basic white color in [Custom Setup] mode
Priority Set in AWB
WB bracket
191
Help Guide
Selects which tone to prioritize when shooting under lighting conditions such as incandescent light when [White Balance]
is set to [Auto].
Related Topic
White Balance
192
Help Guide
In a scene where the ambient light consists of multiple types of light sources, it is recommended to use the custom white
balance in order to accurately reproduce the whiteness. You can register 3 settings.
2 Hold the product so that the white area fully covers the circle located in the center of the screen, and then
press the center of the control wheel.
After the shutter sound beeps, the calibrated values (Color Temperature and Color Filter) are displayed.
3 Select a registration number using the left/right sides of the control wheel, and then press the center.
The monitor returns to the recording information display while retaining the memorized custom white balance
setting.
The registered custom white balance setting will remain memorized until overwritten by the another setting.
Note
The message [Custom WB Error] indicates that the value is in the unexpected range, for example when the subject is too vivid.
You can register the setting at this point, but it is recommended that you set the white balance again. When an error value is set,
the indicator turns orange on the recording information display. The indicator will be displayed in white when the set value
is in the expected range.
If you use a flash when capturing a shot, the custom white balance will be registered with the flash light. Shoot images with a
flash when recalling a setting registered with the flash.
193
Help Guide
Creative Style
Allows you to set the desired image processing and finely adjust contrast, saturation and sharpness for each image
style. You can adjust exposure (shutter speed and aperture) as you like with this function, unlike with [Scene Selection],
where the product adjusts the exposure.
2 Select the desired style or [Style Box] using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
3 To adjust (Contrast), (Saturation) and (Sharpness), select the desired item using the right/left
sides, and then select the value using the top/bottom sides.
4 When selecting [Style Box], move to the right side using the right side of the control wheel, and then select
the desired style.
You can call up the same style with slightly different settings.
Contrast:
The higher the value selected, the more the difference of light and shadow is accentuated, and the bigger the effect on
the image.
Saturation:
The higher the value selected, the more vivid the color. When a lower value is selected, the color of the image is
restrained and subdued.
Sharpness:
Adjusts the sharpness. The higher the value selected, the more the contours are accentuated, and the lower the value
selected, the more the contours are softened.
Note
[Creative Style] is fixed to [Standard] in the following situations:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
[Picture Effect] is set to other than [Off].
[Picture Profile] is set to other than [Off].
When this function is set to [Black & White] or [Sepia], [Saturation] cannot be adjusted.
195
Help Guide
Picture Effect
Select the desired effect filter to achieve more impressive and artistic images.
Hint
You can perform detailed settings for some items using the left/right sides of the control wheel.
Note
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, setting the zoom scale larger makes [Toy Camera] less effective.
When [Partial Color] is selected, images may not retain the selected color, depending on the subject or shooting conditions.
You cannot check the following effects on the shooting screen, because the product processes the image after the shot. Also, you
cannot shoot another image until image processing is finished. You cannot use these effects with movies.
[Rich-tone Mono.]
In the case of [Rich-tone Mono.], the shutter is released three times for one shot. Be careful about the following:
Use this function when the subject is motionless or does not flash light.
Do not change the composition during shooting.
When the contrast of the scene is low or when significant camera-shake or subject blur has occurred, you may not be able to
obtain good HDR images. If the product detects such a situation, appear on the recorded image to inform you of this
situation. Change the composition or re-shoot the image carefully to avoid image blur, as needed.
When [ File Format] is set to [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG], this function is not available.
196
4-732-947-15(1) Copyright 2018 Sony Corporation
197
Help Guide
The way colors are represented using combinations of numbers or the range of color reproduction is called “color
space.” You can change the color space depending on the purpose of the image.
Note
[AdobeRGB] is for applications or printers that support color management and DCF2.0 option color space. Images may not be
printed or viewed in the correct colors if you use applications or printers that do not support Adobe RGB.
When displaying images that were recorded with [AdobeRGB] on non-Adobe RGB-compliant devices, the images will be
displayed with low saturation.
198
Help Guide
Detects flickering/blinking from artificial light sources such as fluorescent lighting and times the shooting of images to
moments when flickering will have less of an impact.
This function reduces differences in the exposure and color tone caused by flickering between the upper area and the
lower area of an image shot with fast shutter speed and during continuous shooting.
2 Press the shutter button halfway down, and then shoot the image.
The product detects flickering when the shutter button is pressed halfway down.
Hint
The color tone of the shot result may vary when you shoot the same scene using a different shutter speed. If that happens, we
recommend that you shoot in [Shutter Priority] or [Manual Exposure] mode with a fixed shutter speed.
You can perform anti-flicker shooting by pressing the shutter button halfway down even when in manual focus mode.
Note
The shutter release lag may increase slightly. In continuous shooting mode, the shooting speed may slow down or the interval
between each shot may become unequal.
The camera detects flickering when the frequency of the light source is 100 Hz or 120 Hz only.
The camera cannot detect flickering depending on the light source and shooting conditions, such as a dark background.
Even if the camera detects flickering, the influences caused by flickering may not be reduced enough depending on the light
source or the shooting situation. We recommend that you take test shots beforehand.
The color tone of the shot results may differ depending on the setting of [ Anti-flicker Shoot.].
199
Help Guide
Sets whether or not the shutter can be released when no lens is attached.
Note
Correct metering cannot be achieved when you use lenses that do not provide a lens contact, such as the lens of an
astronomical telescope. In such cases, adjust the exposure manually by checking it on the recorded image.
200
Help Guide
Sets whether the shutter can be released when no memory card has been inserted.
Note
When no memory card has been inserted, the images shot will not be saved.
The default setting is [Enable]. It is recommended that you select [Disable] prior to actual shooting.
201
Help Guide
Note
Use the [ Silent Shooting] function on your own responsibility, while taking sufficient consideration to the privacy and portrait
rights of the subject.
Even if [ Silent Shooting] is set to [On], the operating sound of the aperture and focus will sound.
When shooting still images using the [ Silent Shooting] function with low ISO sensitivity, if you point the camera at a very
bright light source, high intensity areas on the monitor may be recorded in darker tones.
When the power is turned off, the shutter sound may beep in rare occasions. This is not a malfunction.
Image distortion caused by the movement of the subject or the camera may occur. The distortion may become more noticeable
when [ RAW File Type] is set to [Uncompressed]. To decrease the distortion, set [ File Format] to [JPEG]. If you want to
shoot images in the RAW format with less distortion, set [Drive Mode] to [Cont. Shooting] and [ RAW File Type] to
[Compressed].
If you shoot images under instantaneous lightning or flickering lights, such as the flash light from other cameras or fluorescent
lighting, a striping effect may occur on the image.
If you want to turn off the beep that sounds when the subject is in focus or the self-timer operates, set [Audio signals] to [Off].
Even if [ Silent Shooting] is set to [On], the shutter sound may beep under the following circumstances:
When you capture a basic white color while the camera is set to the [Custom Setup] mode under [White Balance]
When you register faces using [Face Registration]
You cannot select [ Silent Shooting] when the mode dial is set to other than P/A/S/M.
When [ Silent Shooting] is set to [On], the following functions are not available:
Flash shooting
Auto HDR
Picture Effect
Picture Profile
Long Exposure NR
e-Front Curtain Shut.
BULB shooting
After you turn the camera on, the time in which you can start recording is extended by approximately 0.5 seconds.
202
Help Guide
The electronic front curtain shutter function shortens the time lag between when the shutter button is pressed and the
shutter is released.
Note
When you shoot at high shutter speeds with a large-aperture lens attached, out-of-focus circle produced by the bokeh effect may
get cut off because of the shutter mechanism. If this happens, set [e-Front Curtain Shut.] to [Off].
When a lens made by another manufacturer (including a Minolta/Konica-Minolta lens) is used, set this function to [Off]. If you set
this function to [On], the correct exposure will not be set or the image brightness will be uneven.
When you shoot at high shutter speeds, the image brightness may become uneven depending on the shooting environment. In
such cases, set [e-Front Curtain Shut.] to [Off].
203
Help Guide
SteadyShot
204
Help Guide
SteadyShot Settings
You can shoot with an appropriate SteadyShot setting for the attached lens.
Note
The SteadyShot function may not work optimally when the power has just been turned on, right after you point the camera
towards a subject, or when the shutter button has been pressed all the way down without stopping halfway.
When using a tripod, etc., make sure to turn off the SteadyShot function because this can cause any malfunction when shooting.
[SteadyShot Settings] will be unavailable when MENU→ (Camera Settings2)→[SteadyShot] is set to [Off].
When the camera cannot obtain focal length information from the lens, the SteadyShot function does not work correctly. Set
[SteadyShot Adjust.] to [Manual] and set [SteadyS. Focal Len.] to match the lens you are using. The current set value of the
SteadyShot focal length will display to the side of .
When using an SEL16F28 lens (sold separately) with a teleconverter, etc., set [SteadyShot Adjust.] to [Manual] and set the focal
length.
When you set [SteadyShot] to [On]/[Off], the SteadyShot settings of the camera and lens switch at the same time.
If a lens equipped with a SteadyShot switch is attached, the settings can only be changed using that switch on the lens. You
cannot switch the settings using the camera.
Related Topic
SteadyShot
205
Help Guide
Lens Comp.
Compensates for shading in the corners of the screen or distortion of the screen, or reduces color deviation at the
corners of the screen caused by certain lens characteristics.
Note
This function is only available when using an automatic compensation compliant lens.
Darkness in the corners of the screen may not be corrected with [Shading Comp.], depending on the lens type.
Depending on the attached lens, [Distortion Comp.] is fixed to [Auto], and you cannot select [Off].
206
Help Guide
When you set the shutter speed to 1 second(s) or longer (long exposure shooting), noise reduction is turned on for the
duration that the shutter is open. With the function turned on, the grainy noise typical of long exposures is reduced.
Note
Noise reduction may not be activated even if [ Long Exposure NR] is set to [On] in the following situations:
The shooting mode is set to [Scene Selection] and [Sports Action] is selected.
[ Long Exposure NR] cannot be set to [Off] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
Depending on the shooting conditions, the camera may not perform noise reduction, even if the shutter speed is 1 second(s) or
longer.
207
Help Guide
When shooting with high ISO sensitivity, the product reduces noise that becomes more noticeable when the product
sensitivity is high.
Note
[ High ISO NR] is not available in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
[ High ISO NR] does not work for RAW images when the [ File Format] is [RAW & JPEG].
208
Help Guide
Sets whether to focus with higher priority on faces registered using [Face Registration].
Hint
To use the [Regist. Faces Priority] function, set as follows.
[Face/Eye Prty in AF] under [Face/Eye AF Set.]: [On]
[Subject Detection] under [Face/Eye AF Set.]: [Human] (when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later)
Related Topic
Face/Eye AF Set.
Face Registration (New Registration)
Face Registration (Order Exchanging)
Version
209
Help Guide
If you register faces in advance, the product can focus on the registered face as a priority.
2 Align the guide frame with the face to be registered, and press the shutter button.
Note
Up to eight faces can be registered.
Shoot the face from the front in a brightly lit place. The face may not be registered correctly if it is obscured by a hat, a mask,
sunglasses, etc.
Related Topic
Face/Eye AF Set.
210
Help Guide
When multiple faces are registered to be given priority, the face registered first will be given priority. You can change the
priority order.
Related Topic
Face/Eye AF Set.
211
Help Guide
If you select [Delete All], you can delete all registered faces.
Note
Even if you execute [Delete], the data for registered face will remain in the product. To delete the data for registered faces from
the product, select [Delete All].
212
Help Guide
In dark environments, use the flash to light up the subject while shooting. Also use the flash to prevent camera-shake.
For details on the flash, refer to the instruction manual for the flash.
2 Shoot after you have turned on the flash and it is fully charged.
Note
The light of the flash may be blocked if the lens hood is attached and the lower part of a recorded image may be shaded.
Remove the lens hood.
When using the flash, stand 1 m or more away from the subject.
You cannot use the flash when recording movies. (You can use an LED light when using a flash (sold separately) with an LED
light.)
Before attaching/removing an accessory such as a flash to/from the Multi Interface Shoe, turn off the product first. When
attaching an accessory, make sure that the accessory is fixed securely to the product.
Do not use the Multi Interface Shoe with a commercially available flash that applies voltage of 250 V or more or has the reverse
polarity of the camera. Doing so may cause a malfunction.
When shooting with the flash and the zoom is set to W, the shadow of the lens may appear on the screen, depending on the
shooting conditions. If this happens, shoot away from the subject or set the zoom to T and shoot with the flash again.
When shooting with an external flash, light and dark stripes may appear on the image if the shutter speed is set to faster than
1/4000 seconds. If this occurs, Sony recommends shooting in the manual flash mode and setting the flash level to 1/2 or higher.
For details on compatible accessories for the Multi Interface Shoe, visit the Sony website, or consult your Sony dealer or local
authorized Sony service facility.
213
Related Topic
Flash Mode
Wireless Flash
214
Help Guide
When using the flash, it is fired two or more times before shooting to reduce the red-eye phenomenon.
Note
Red Eye Reduction may not produce the desired effects. It depends on individual differences and conditions, such as distance to
the subject, or whether the subject looks at the pre-strobe or not.
215
Help Guide
Flash Mode
Note
The default setting depends on the shooting mode.
Some [Flash Mode] settings are not available, depending on the shooting mode.
Related Topic
Using flash (sold separately)
Wireless Flash
216
Help Guide
Flash Comp.
Adjusts the amount of flash light in a range of –3.0 EV to +3.0 EV. Flash compensation changes the amount of flash light
only. Exposure compensation changes the amount of flash light along with the change of the shutter speed and aperture.
Selecting higher values (+ side) makes the flash level higher, and lower values (- side) makes the flash level
lower.
Note
[Flash Comp.] does not work when the shooting mode is set to the following modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
The higher flash effect (+ side) may not be visible due to the limited amount of flash light available, if the subject is outside the
maximum range of the flash. If the subject is very close, the lower flash effect (- side) may not be visible.
If you attach an ND filter to the lens or attach a diffuser or a color filter to the flash, the appropriate exposure may not be achieved
and images may turn out dark. In this case, adjust [Flash Comp.] to the desired value.
Related Topic
Using flash (sold separately)
217
Help Guide
FEL lock
The flash level is automatically adjusted so that the subject gets the optimum exposure during normal flash shooting. You
can also set the flash level in advance.
FEL: Flash Exposure Level
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → desired button, then assign the [FEL Lock
toggle] function to the button.
2 Center the subject on which FEL is to be locked, and adjust the focus.
3 Press the button to which [FEL Lock toggle] is registered, and set the flash amount.
A pre-flash flashes.
The (FEL lock) lights up.
When you want to release the FEL lock, press the button to which the [FEL Lock toggle] is registered again.
Hint
By setting [FEL Lock hold], you can hold the setting while the button is pressed down. Also, by setting [FEL Lock/AEL hold] and
[FEL Lock/AEL tggle.], you can shoot images with the AE locked in the following situations.
When [Flash Mode] is set to [Flash Off] or [Autoflash].
When the flash cannot go off.
When using an external flash that is set to manual flash mode.
Note
218
The FEL lock cannot be set when a flash is not attached.
If a flash that does not support the FEL lock is attached, an error message is displayed.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
219
Help Guide
You can configure the settings of a flash (sold separately) attached to the camera using the monitor and control wheel of
the camera.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.10 or later. Also, update the software
of your flash to the latest version before using this function.
For details on flash functions, refer to the instruction manual for the flash.
1 Attach the flash (sold separately) to the Multi Interface Shoe of the camera, and then turn on the camera
and the flash.
Hint
If you assign the [Ext. Flash Firing Set.] function to a key in advance by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [
Custom Key], you can call up the [Ext. Flash Firing Set.] screen simply by pressing that key.
You can adjust settings by operating the flash even while you are using [External Flash Set.].
You can also configure the settings for a Wireless Radio Commander (sold separately) attached to the camera.
Note
You can only use [External Flash Set.] to configure the settings of a flash (sold separately) or Wireless Radio Commander (sold
separately) manufactured by Sony and attached to the Multi Interface Shoe of the camera.
You can only use [External Flash Set.] when the flash is attached directly to the camera. You cannot use this function when
shooting with an off-camera flash that is connected using a cable.
Only some of the functions of the attached flash are configurable using [External Flash Set.]. You cannot perform pairing with
other flashes, reset the flash, initialize the flash, etc. via [External Flash Set.].
Also, [External Flash Set.] may be unavailable depending on the state of the flash.
For details on flashes and Wireless Radio Commanders that are compatible with this function, refer to the following support page.
https://www.sony.net/dics/7m3/
Related Topic
220
Version
221
Help Guide
Wireless Flash
There are two methods for wireless flash shooting: light-signal flash shooting that uses the light of the flash attached to
the camera as a signal light, and radio-signal flash shooting that uses wireless communication. To perform radio-signal
flash shooting, use a compatible flash or the Wireless Radio Commander (sold separately). For details on how to set
each method, refer to the instruction manual of the flash or the Wireless Radio Commander.
1 Remove the shoe cap from the camera, and then attach the flash or the Wireless Radio Commander.
When performing wireless flash shooting with a flash attached, set the attached flash as the controller.
3 Set up an off-camera flash that is set to wireless mode, or that is attached to the Wireless Radio Receiver
(sold separately).
Note
The off-camera flash may emit light after receiving a light signal from a flash used as the controller of another camera. If this
occurs, change the channel of your flash. For details on how to change the channel, refer to the instruction manual for the flash.
For the flash that is compatible with wireless flash shooting, visit the Sony website, or consult your Sony dealer or local
authorized Sony service facility.
222
Help Guide
Shooting movies
Since the [MOVIE Button] is set to [Always] in the default setting, movie recording can be started from any
shooting mode.
Hint
You can assign the start/stop movie recording function to a preferred key. MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom
Key] → set [MOVIE] to the preferred key.
When you want to specify the area to be focused on, set the area using [Focus Area].
To keep the focus on a face, arrange the composition so that the focusing frame and face detection frame overlap, or set the
[Focus Area] to [Wide].
You can focus quickly while shooting movies by pressing the shutter button halfway down. (The sound of auto focus operation
may be recorded in some cases.)
To adjust the shutter speed and aperture value to the desired settings, set the shooting mode to (Movie) and select the
desired exposure mode.
An icon indicating that data is being written is displayed after shooting. Do not remove the memory card while the icon is
displayed.
The following settings for still image shooting are applied to the movie shooting:
White Balance
Creative Style
Metering Mode
Face/Eye Prty in AF
Face Prty in Mlti Mtr
D-Range Opt.
Lens Comp.
You can change the settings for ISO sensitivity, exposure compensation, and focus area while shooting movies.
While shooting movies, the recorded image can be output without the shooting information display by setting [HDMI Info. Display]
to [Off].
223
Note
The sound of the lens and the product in operation may be recorded during movie recording.
You can turn the sound off by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Audio Recording] → [Off].
When shooting, the sound of the shoulder strap hooks (triangular hook) could be recorded, depending on the situation used.
To prevent the operating sound of the zoom ring from being recorded during movie recording when a power zoom lens is used,
we recommend recording movies using the zoom lever. When you move the zoom lever, place your finger lightly on the lever and
operate it without flicking.
The temperature of the camera tends to rise when shooting movies continuously, and you may feel that the camera is warm. This
is not a malfunction. Also, [Internal temp. high. Allow it to cool.] may appear. In such cases, turn the power off and cool the
camera and wait until the camera is ready to shoot again.
If the icon appears, the temperature of the camera has risen. Turn the power off and cool the camera and wait until the
camera is ready to shoot again.
For the continuous shooting time of a movie recording, refer to “Recordable movie times.” When movie recording is finished, you
can restart recording by pressing the MOVIE button again. Recording may stop to protect the product, depending on the
temperature of the product or the battery.
When the mode dial is set to (Movie) or or when shooting movies, you cannot select [Lock-on AF] for [Focus Area].
In [Program Auto] mode when shooting movies, the aperture value and the shutter speed will be set automatically and cannot be
changed. For that reason, the shutter speed may become fast in a bright environment, and the motion of the subject may not
record smoothly. By changing the exposure mode and adjusting the aperture value and the shutter speed, the motion of the
subject can be recorded smoothly.
When shooting movies, ISO values between ISO 100 and ISO 102400 are available. If the ISO value is set to a value larger than
ISO 102400, the setting is automatically switched to ISO 102400. When you finish recording the movie, the ISO value returns to
the original setting.
In movie shooting mode, ISO sensitivity can be selected from ISO 100 to ISO 102400. If the ISO value is set to a value smaller
than ISO 100, the setting is automatically switched to ISO 100. When you finish recording the movie, the ISO value returns to the
original setting.
In movie shooting mode, the following settings cannot be set in [Picture Effect]. When a movie recording starts, [Off] will be set
temporarily.
Rich-tone Mono.
If you point the camera at an extremely strong light source while shooting a movie at low ISO sensitivity, the highlighted area in
the image may be recorded as a black area.
If the display mode of the monitor is set to [For viewfinder], the display mode will switch to [Display All Info.] when movie shooting
starts.
Use PlayMemories Home when importing XAVC S movies and AVCHD movies to a computer.
Related Topic
MOVIE Button
Movie w/ shutter
File Format (movie)
Recordable movie times
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Focus Area
224
Help Guide
Movie w/ shutter
You can start or stop recording movies by pressing the shutter button, which is bigger and easier to press than the
MOVIE (Movie) button.
Hint
When [Movie w/ shutter] is set to [On], you can still start or stop recording movies using the MOVIE button.
When [Movie w/ shutter] is set to [On], you can use the shutter button to start or stop recording movies on an external
recording/playback device using [ REC Control].
Note
When [Movie w/ shutter] is set to [On], you cannot focus by pressing the shutter button halfway down during movie recording.
Related Topic
Shooting movies
225
Help Guide
The following movie recording formats are available with this camera.
What is XAVC S?
Records movies in high definition such as 4K by converting them into MP4 movies using the MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 codec.
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 is capable of compressing images with higher efficiency. You can record high-quality images while
reducing the amount of data.
Related Topic
File Format (movie)
Record Setting (movie)
AVCHD format
226
Help Guide
File Characteristics
Format
XAVC Records movies in crisper quality than AVCHD You can save movies on a computer using the
S HD with larger amounts of data. PlayMemories Home software.
The AVCHD format has a high degree of You can save movies on a computer or create a disc that
AVCHD compatibility with storage devices other than supports this format using the PlayMemories Home
computers. software.
Note
When [ File Format] is set to [AVCHD], the file size of movies is limited to approx. 2 GB. If the movie file size reaches approx.
2 GB during recording, a new movie file will be created automatically.
If you set [ File Format] to [XAVC S 4K] and shoot movies while the camera is connected to an HDMI device, images will not
be displayed on the monitor.
227
Help Guide
30p 100M/25p 100M Approx. 100 Mbps Records movies in 3840×2160 (30p/25p).
Record
Bit-rate Description
Setting
Approx. 50
24p 50M* Records movies in 1920×1080 (24p).
Mbps
228
Record
Bit-rate Description
Setting
60i 17M(FH)/50i 17M(FH) Approx. 17 Mbps on average Records movies in 1920×1080 (60i/50i).
Note
Creating an AVCHD recording disc from movies that were recorded with [60i 24M(FX)]/[50i 24M(FX)] as the [ Record Setting]
takes a long time because the image quality of movies is converted. If you want to store movies without converting them, use a
Blu-ray Disc.
In full-frame shooting, the angle of view will be narrower under the following conditions:
When [ File Format] is set to [XAVC S 4K] and [ Record Setting] is set to [30p]
Related Topic
APS-C/Super 35mm
Angle of view
229
Help Guide
S&Q Settings
You can record a moment that cannot be captured by the naked eye (slow-motion recording), or record a long-term
phenomenon into a compressed movie (quick-motion recording). For example, you can record an intense sports scene,
the moment when a bird starts to fly, a blooming flower, and a changing view of clouds or a starry sky. Sound will not be
recorded.
2 Select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Exposure Mode] → and select the desired setting of
slow-motion/quick-motion ( Program Auto, Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or
Manual Exposure).
3 Select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ S&Q Settings] and select the desired settings for [
Record Setting] and [ Frame Rate].
Playback speed
The playback speed will vary as below depending on the assigned [ Record Setting] and [ Frame Rate].
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to NTSC
Record Setting
Frame Rate
24p 30p 60p
230
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to PAL
Record Setting
Frame Rate
25p 50p
When [ Frame Rate] is set to [120fps]/[100fps], you cannot set [ Record Setting] to [60p]/[50p].
Note
In slow-motion recording, the shutter speed becomes faster and you may not be able to obtain the proper exposure. If this
happens, decrease the aperture value or adjust the ISO sensitivity to a higher value.
The bit-rate of a recorded movie varies depending on the settings for [ Frame Rate] and [ Record Setting].
Related Topic
S&Q Motion: Exposure Mode
Recordable movie times
231
Help Guide
Proxy Recording
Sets whether to simultaneously record low-bit-rate proxy movies when recording XAVC S movies. Since proxy movies
are small in file size, they are suitable for transferring to smartphones or uploading to websites.
Hint
Proxy movies are recorded in the XAVC S HD format (1280×720) at 9 Mbps. The frame rate of the proxy movie is the same as
that of the original movie.
Proxy movies are not displayed on the playback screen (single-image playback screen or image index screen). is displayed
over movies for which a proxy movie was simultaneously recorded.
Note
Proxy movies cannot be played back on this camera.
Deleting/protecting movies that have proxy movies removes/protects both the original and proxy movies. You cannot
delete/protect only original movies or proxy movies.
Related Topic
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Sending Target (proxy movies)
Movie recording formats
Playing back images on the image index screen (Image Index)
Memory cards that can be used
232
Help Guide
Audio Recording
Sets whether to record sounds when shooting movies. Select [Off] to avoid recording the sounds of the lens and the
camera operating.
233
Help Guide
Note
The audio level is not displayed in the following situations:
When [Audio Recording] is set to [Off].
When DISP (Display Setting) is set to [No Disp. Info.].
During slow-motion/quick-motion shooting
The audio level is also displayed while shooting stand-by in movie recording mode.
234
Help Guide
You can adjust the audio recording level while checking the level meter.
2 Select the desired level using the right/left sides of the control wheel.
Hint
When you record audio movies with loud volumes, set [Audio Rec Level] to a lower sound level. Doing so enables you to record
more realistic audio. When you record audio movies with lower volumes, set [Audio Rec Level] to a greater sound level to make
the sound easier to hear.
Note
Regardless of the [Audio Rec Level] settings, the limiter always operates.
[Audio Rec Level] is available only when the shooting mode is set to movie mode.
The [Audio Rec Level] settings are applied for both the internal microphone and the (microphone) terminal input.
235
Help Guide
You can set echo cancellation during audio monitoring and prevent undesirable deviations between video and audio
during HDMI output.
236
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to reduce wind noise by cutting the low-range sound of the input audio from the built-in microphone.
Note
Setting this item to [On] where wind is not blowing sufficiently hard may cause normal sound to be recorded with too low volume.
When an external microphone (sold separately) is used, [Wind Noise Reduct.] does not function.
237
Help Guide
Picture Profile
Allows you to change the settings for the color, gradation, etc. For details on “Picture Profile,” refer to
http://helpguide.sony.net/di/pp/v1/en/index.html.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Picture Profile] → the profile you want to change.
2 Move to the item index screen by pressing the right side of the control wheel.
3 Select the item to change using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
4 Select the desired value using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel and press in the center.
The default settings [PP1] through [PP10] for movies have been set in advance in the camera based on various shooting
conditions.
MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Picture Profile] → desired setting.
PP1:
Example setting using [Movie] gamma.
PP2:
Example setting using [Still] gamma.
PP3:
Example setting of natural color tone using the [ITU709] gamma.
PP4:
Example setting of a color tone faithful to the ITU709 standard.
PP5:
Example setting using [Cine1] gamma.
PP6:
Example setting using [Cine2] gamma.
PP7:
Example setting using [S-Log2] gamma.
PP8:
Example setting using the [S-Log3] gamma and the [S-Gamut3.Cine] under [Color Mode].
PP9:
Example setting using the [S-Log3] gamma and the [S-Gamut3] under [Color Mode].
PP10:
Example setting for recording HDR movies using [HLG2] gamma.
Black Level
Sets the black level. (–15 to +15)
Gamma
Selects a gamma curve.
Movie: Standard gamma curve for movies
Still: Standard gamma curve for still images
Cine1: Softens the contrast in dark parts and emphasizes gradation in bright parts to produce a relaxed color movie.
(equivalent to HG4609G33)
Cine2: Similar to [Cine1] but optimized for editing with up to 100% video signal. (equivalent to HG4600G30)
Cine3: Intensifies the contrast in light and shade more than [Cine1] and strengthens gradation in black.
Cine4: Strengthens the contrast in dark parts more than [Cine3].
ITU709: Gamma curve that corresponds to ITU709.
ITU709(800%): Gamma curve for confirming scenes on the assumption of shooting using [S-Log2] or [S-Log3].
S-Log2: Gamma curve for [S-Log2]. This setting is based on the assumption that the picture will be processed after
shooting.
S-Log3: Gamma curve for [S-Log3] with more similar features to film. This setting is based on the assumption that the
picture will be processed after shooting.
HLG: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Equivalent to the HDR standard Hybrid Log-Gamma, ITU-R BT.2100.
HLG1: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Emphasizes noise reduction. However, shooting is restricted to a narrower
dynamic range than with [HLG2] or [HLG3].
HLG2: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Provides a balance of dynamic range and noise reduction.
HLG3: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Wider dynamic range than [HLG2]. However, noise may increase.
[HLG1], [HLG2], and [HLG3] all apply a gamma curve with the same characteristics, but each offers a different
balance between dynamic range and noise reduction. Each has a different maximum video output level, as follows:
[HLG1]: approx. 87%, [HLG2]: approx. 95%, [HLG3]: approx. 100%.
Black Gamma
Corrects gamma in low intensity areas.
[Black Gamma] is fixed at “0” and cannot be adjusted when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3].
Range: Selects the correcting range. (Wide / Middle / Narrow)
Level: Sets the correcting level. (-7 (maximum black compression) to +7 (maximum black stretch))
Knee
Sets knee point and slope for video signal compression to prevent over-exposure by limiting signals in high intensity
areas of the subject to the dynamic range of your camera.
[Knee] is disabled if [Mode] is set to [Auto] when [Gamma] is set to [Still], [Cine1], [Cine2], [Cine3], [Cine4],
[ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2], [S-Log3], [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3]. To enable [Knee], set [Mode] to [Manual].
Mode: Selects auto/manual settings.
Auto: The knee point and slope are set automatically.
Manual: The knee point and slope are set manually.
239
Slope: Sets the knee slope. (-5 (gentle) to +5 (steep))
Color Mode
Sets type and level of colors.
In [Color Mode], only [BT.2020] and [709] are available when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3].
Movie: Suitable colors when [Gamma] is set to [Movie].
Still: Suitable colors when [Gamma] is set to [Still].
Cinema: Suitable colors when [Gamma] is set to [Cine1] or [Cine2].
Pro: Similar color tones to the standard image quality of Sony professional cameras (when combined with ITU709
gamma)
ITU709 Matrix: Colors corresponding to ITU709 standard (when combined with ITU709 gamma)
Black & White: Sets the saturation to zero for shooting in black and white.
S-Gamut: Setting based on the assumption that the pictures will be processed after shooting. Used when [Gamma] is set
to [S-Log2].
S-Gamut3.Cine: Setting based on the assumption that the pictures will be processed after shooting. Used when
[Gamma] is set to [S-Log3]. This setting allows you to shoot in a color space that can easily be converted for digital
cinema.
S-Gamut3: Setting based on the assumption that the pictures will be processed after shooting. Used when [Gamma] is
set to [S-Log3]. This setting allows you to shoot in a wide color space.
BT.2020: Standard color tone when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3].
709: Color tone when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3] and movies are recorded with HDTV color
(BT.709).
Saturation
Sets the color saturation. (-32 to +32)
Color Phase
Sets the color phase. (-7 to +7)
Color Depth
Sets the color depth for each color phase. This function is more effective for chromatic colors and less effective for
achromatic colors. The color looks deeper as you increase the setting value towards the positive side, and lighter as you
decrease the value towards the negative side. This function is effective even if you set [Color Mode] to [Black & White].
[R] -7 (light red) to +7 (deep red)
[G] -7 (light green) to +7 (deep green)
[B] -7 (light blue) to +7 (deep blue)
[C] -7 (light cyan) to +7 (deep cyan)
[M] -7 (light magenta) to +7 (deep magenta)
[Y] -7 (light yellow) to +7 (deep yellow)
Detail
Sets items for [Detail].
Level: Sets the [Detail] level. (-7 to +7)
Adjust: The following parameters can be selected manually.
Mode: Selects auto/manual setting. (Auto (automatic optimization) / Manual (The details are set manually.))
V/H Balance: Sets the vertical (V) and horizontal (H) balance of DETAIL. (-2 (off to the vertical (V) side) to +2 (off to
the horizontal (H) side))
B/W Balance: Selects the balance of the lower DETAIL (B) and the upper DETAIL (W). (Type1 (off to the lower
DETAIL (B) side) to Type5 (off to the upper DETAIL (W) side))
Limit: Sets the limit level of [Detail]. (0 (Low limit level: likely to be limited) to 7 (High limit level: unlikely to be limited))
Crispning: Sets the crispening level. (0 (shallow crispening level) to 7 (deep crispening level))
Hi-Light Detail: Sets the [Detail] level in the high intensity areas. (0 to 4)
240
You can copy the settings of the picture profile to another picture profile number.
MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Picture Profile] → [Copy].
Note
Since the parameters are shared for movie and still images, adjust the value when you change the shooting mode.
If you develop RAW images with shooting settings, the following settings are not reflected:
Black Level
Black Gamma
Knee
Color Depth
There may be more noise in dark parts depending on the gamma settings. It may improve by setting the lens compensation to
[Off].
When using S-Log2 or S-Log3 gamma, the noise becomes more noticeable compared to when using other gammas. If the noise
still is significant even after processing pictures, it may be improved by shooting with a brighter setting. However, the dynamic
range becomes narrower accordingly when you shoot with a brighter setting. We recommend checking the picture in advance by
test shooting when using S-Log2 or S-Log3.
Setting [ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2] or [S-Log3] may cause an error in the white balance custom setup. In this case, perform
custom setup with a gamma other than [ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2], or [S-Log3] first, and then reselect [ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2],
or [S-Log3] gamma.
If you set [Slope] to +5 in [Manual Set] under [Knee], [Knee] is set to [Off].
S-Gamut, S-Gamut3.Cine, and S-Gamut3 are color spaces exclusive to Sony. However, this camera's S-Gamut setting does not
support the whole S-Gamut color space; it is a setting to achieve a color reproduction equivalent to S-Gamut.
Related Topic
Gamma Disp. Assist
241
Help Guide
Movies with S-Log gamma are assumed to be processed after shooting in order to make use of the wide dynamic range.
Movies with the HLG gamma are assumed to be displayed on HDR-compatible monitors. They are therefore displayed in
low contrast during shooting and may be difficult to monitor, using [Gamma Disp. Assist], contrast equivalent to that of
normal gamma can be reproduced. In addition, [Gamma Disp. Assist] can also be applied when playing back movies on
the camera's monitor/viewfinder.
2 Select the desired setting using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
Note
Movies in the XAVC S 4K or XAVC S HD format with the [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3] gamma are displayed with an
[HLG(BT.2020)] effect or [HLG(709)] effect depending on the movie’s gamma value and color mode. In other situations, movies
are displayed according to the gamma setting and color mode setting in [Picture Profile].
[Gamma Disp. Assist] is not applied to movies when displayed on a TV or monitor connected to the camera.
Related Topic
Picture Profile
242
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to adjust the shutter speed automatically when recording movies if the subject is dark.
Note
[ Auto Slow Shut.] does not function in the following situations:
During slow-motion/quick-motion shooting
(Shutter Priority)
(Manual Exposure)
When [ISO] is set to other than [ISO AUTO]
243
Help Guide
You can switch focusing speed when using autofocus in movie mode.
244
Help Guide
245
Help Guide
TC/UB Settings
The time code (TC) and the user bit (UB) information can be recorded as data attached to movies.
3. Set the other digits following the same procedure as in step 2, then press in the center of the control wheel.
How to select the recording method for the time code (TC Format *1)
246
1. MENU → (Setup) → [TC/UB Settings] → [TC Format].
DF:
Records the time code in Drop Frame*2 format.
NDF:
Records the time code in Non-Drop Frame format.
*1 Only when [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to NTSC.
*2 The time code is based on 30 frames per second. However, a gap between the actual time and the time code will occur during extended periods
of recording as the frame frequency of the NTSC image signal is approximately 29.97 frames per second. Drop frame corrects this gap to make
the time code and actual time equal. In drop frame, the first 2 frame numbers are removed every minute except for every tenth minute. The time
code without this correction is called non-drop frame.
The setting is fixed to [NDF] when recording in 4K/24p or 1080/24p.
How to select the count up format for the time code (TC Run)
Rec Run:
Sets the stepping mode for the time code to advance only while recording. The time code is recorded sequentially from
the last time code of the previous recording.
Free Run:
Sets the stepping mode for the time code to advance anytime, regardless of the camera operation.
The time code may not be recorded sequentially in the following situations even when the time code advances in
[Rec Run] mode.
When the recording format is changed.
When the recording medium is removed.
247
Help Guide
Allows you to display the time code (TC) and user bit (UB) of a movie by pressing the key to which [TC/UB Disp. Switch]
function has been assigned.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key], [ Custom Key], or [ Custom Key] → assign
the [TC/UB Disp. Switch] function to the desired key.
248
Help Guide
MOVIE Button
249
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to display markers set using [ Marker Settings] on the monitor or the viewfinder while shooting
movies.
Note
The markers are displayed when the mode dial is set to (Movie) or , or when shooting movies.
The markers are displayed on the monitor or viewfinder. (You cannot output the markers.)
Related Topic
Marker Settings (movie)
250
Help Guide
Hint
You can display several markers at the same time.
Place the subject on the cross point of the [Guideframe] to make a balanced composition.
251
Help Guide
You can set how to record movies and perform HDMI output when your camera is connected to 4K-compatible external
recording/playback devices, etc.
Note
This item can be set only when the camera is in movie mode and connected to a 4K-compatible device.
When [HDMI Only(30p)], [HDMI Only(24p)] or [HDMI Only(25p)] is set, [HDMI Info. Display] will temporarily be set to [Off].
A 4K movie is not output to the connected 4K-compatible device during slow-motion/quick-motion shooting.
When [HDMI Only(30p)], [HDMI Only(24p)] or [HDMI Only(25p)] is set, the counter does not move forward (the actual recording
time is not counted) while the movie is being recorded on an external recording/playback device.
When [ File Format] is set to [XAVC S 4K] and the camera is connected via HDMI, the following functions are not available.
[Face/Eye Prty in AF]
[Face Prty in Mlti Mtr]
[Center Lock-on AF]
Related Topic
HDMI Settings: REC Control (movie)
File Format (movie)
Record Setting (movie)
HDMI Settings: HDMI Info. Display
252
Help Guide
Sets the illumination setting for the HVL-LBPC LED light (sold separately).
253
Help Guide
Hint
The product creates an image database file on a memory card to record and play back images. An image that is not registered in
the image database file may not be played back correctly. To play back images shot using other devices, register those images to
the image database file using MENU → (Setup) → [Recover Image DB].
If you play back the images right after continuous shooting, the monitor may display an icon indicating that data is being
written/the number of images left to write. During writing, some functions are not available.
You can also enlarge an image by double-tapping the monitor. In addition, you can drag and move the magnified position on the
monitor. Set [Touch Operation] to [On] beforehand.
Related Topic
Recover Image DB
Selecting which memory card to play back (Select PB Media)
254
Help Guide
Enlarges the image being played back. Use this function to check the focus of the image, etc.
1 Display the image you want to enlarge, and then press the button.
Turn the control wheel to adjust the zoom scale. By rotating the front/rear dial, you can switch to the previous or
next image while keeping the same zoom scale.
The view will zoom in on the part of the image where the camera focused during shooting. If the focus location
information cannot be obtained, the camera will zoom in on the center of the image.
2 Select the portion you want to enlarge by pressing the top/bottom/right/left sides of the control wheel.
3 Press the MENU button or the center of the control wheel to exit the playback zoom.
Hint
You can also enlarge an image being played back using MENU.
You can change the initial magnification and initial position of enlarged images by selecting MENU → (Playback) → [
Enlarge Init. Mag.] or [ Enlarge Initial Pos.].
You can also enlarge an image by double-tapping the monitor. In addition, you can drag and move the magnified position on the
monitor. Set [Touch Operation] to [On] beforehand.
Note
You cannot enlarge movies.
Related Topic
Touch Operation
Enlarge Init. Mag.
Enlarge Initial Pos.
255
Help Guide
Related Topic
Rotating an image (Rotate)
256
Help Guide
Note
You cannot rotate the movies.
You may not be able to rotate images shot using other products.
When viewing rotated images on a computer, the images may be displayed in their original orientation depending on the
software.
257
Help Guide
Sets the initial magnification scale when playing back enlarged images.
Related Topic
Enlarging an image being played back (Enlarge Image)
Enlarge Initial Pos.
258
Help Guide
Related Topic
Enlarging an image being played back (Enlarge Image)
Enlarge Init. Mag.
259
Help Guide
2 Select the movie to be played back using the control wheel and press the center of the control wheel to
start playback.
: Playback
: Pause
: Fast-forward
: Fast-rewind
: Forward slow playback
: Reverse slow playback
: Next movie file
: Previous movie file
: Displays the next frame
: Displays the previous frame
: Photo Capture
: Sound volume adjustment
: Closes the operation panel
Hint
“Forward slow playback,” “Reverse slow playback,” “Displays the next frame” and “Displays the previous frame” are available
during pause.
Movie files recorded using other products may not be able to be playable on this camera.
Related Topic
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
Selecting which memory card to play back (Select PB Media)
260
Help Guide
Volume Settings
261
Help Guide
Photo Capture
Captures a chosen scene in a movie to save as a still image. First shoot a movie, then pause the movie during playback
to capture decisive moments that tend to be missed when shooting still images, and save them as still images.
4 Find the desired scene using forward slow playback, reverse slow playback, displays the next frame, and
displays the previous frame, and then stop the movie.
Related Topic
Shooting movies
Playing back movies
262
Help Guide
You can display multiple images at the same time in playback mode.
1 Press the (Image Index) button while the image is being played back.
2 Select the image by pressing the top/bottom/right/left sides of the control wheel or turning the control
wheel.
Related Topic
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
263
Help Guide
Setting the method for jumping between images (Image Jump Setting)
Sets which dial and method to use for jumping between images during playback. You can quickly find protected images
or images set with a particular rating.
Note
[Image Jump Setting] is available only when [View Mode] is set to [Date View]. If [View Mode] is not set to [Date View], the
camera will always play back every image without jumping when you use the dial selected with [Select Dial].
When you use the Image Jump function, movie files are always skipped.
Related Topic
Rating
Protecting images (Protect)
264
Help Guide
265
Help Guide
Display as Group
Sets whether or not to display continuously shot images or images shot using interval shooting as a group.
Hint
The following images are grouped.
Images shot with [Drive Mode] set to [Cont. Shooting] (One sequence of images shot continuously by holding down the shutter
button during continuous shooting becomes one group.)
Images shot with [ Intvl. Shoot. Func.] (Images shot during one session of interval shooting become one group.)
Note
Images can be grouped and displayed only when [View Mode] is set to [Date View]. When it is not set to [Date View], images
cannot be grouped and displayed, even if [Display as Group] is set to [On].
If you delete the group, all the images in the group will be deleted.
Related Topic
Cont. Shooting
Intvl. Shoot. Func.
266
Help Guide
2 Select the image group that you want to play back, and then press the center of the control wheel.
Hint
On the playback screen, you can start continuous playback by pressing the down button while displaying an image in the group.
You can resume play or pause by pressing the down button during playback.
You can change the playback speed by turning the front dial, rear dial, or control wheel during playback. You can also change the
playback speed by selecting MENU → (Playback) → [PB Speed for Intvl].
You can continuously play back images shot with continuous shooting as well.
Related Topic
Intvl. Shoot. Func.
PB Speed for Intvl
Imaging Edge
Version
267
Help Guide
Sets the playback speed for still images during [Cont. PB for Intvl.].
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
Hint
You can also change the playback speed by turning the front dial, rear dial, or control wheel during [Cont. PB for Intvl.].
Related Topic
Cont. PB for Intvl.
Version
268
Help Guide
Note
No image is played back when no memory card is inserted in the selected slot. Select a slot into which a memory card has been
inserted.
When you select [Date View] in [View Mode], the camera only plays back images from a memory card selected using [Select PB
Media].
Related Topic
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
269
Help Guide
You can copy images from a memory card in a slot that is selected using [Select PB Media] to a memory card in another
slot.
All of the contents with a date or in a folder currently being played back will be copied to a memory card in another
slot.
Hint
You can select the type of images to be displayed by selecting MENU → (Playback) → [View Mode].
Note
If images in a group are copied, the copied images will not be displayed as a group on the destination memory card.
If protected images are copied, the protection will be canceled on the destination memory card.
It may take a long time when many images are to be copied. Use a sufficiently charged battery pack.
XAVC S movies can only be copied to a memory card that supports XAVC S movies. A message will be displayed on the monitor
of the camera when images cannot be copied.
Related Topic
Selecting which memory card to play back (Select PB Media)
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
270
Help Guide
2 Select [Enter].
Hint
During playback, you can display the next/previous image by pressing the right/left side of the control wheel.
You can activate a slideshow only when [View Mode] is set to [Date View] or [Folder View(Still)].
271
Help Guide
Protects recorded images against accidental erasure. The mark is displayed on protected images.
Hint
The [Protect] function is assigned to the C3 button in the default settings.
If you select a group in [Multiple Img.], all the images in the group will be protected. To select and protect particular images within
the group, execute [Multiple Img.] while displaying the images within the group.
Note
The menu items that can be selected vary according to the [View Mode] setting and the selected content.
272
Help Guide
Rating
You can assign ratings to recorded images on a scale from to to make it easier to find images. Combining this
function with [Image Jump Setting] allows you to find a desired image quickly.
2 Press the left/right sides of the control wheel to display an image to which you want to assign a rating, and
then press the center.
3 Select the number of (Rating) by pressing the left/right sides of the control wheel, and then press the
center.
Hint
You can also assign ratings when playing back images by using the custom key. Assign [Rating] to the desired key using [
Custom Key] beforehand, and then press the custom key while playing back an image to which you want to assign a rating. The
number of (Rating) changes each time you press the custom key.
Note
You can assign ratings to still images only.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Rating Set(Cust Key)
Setting the method for jumping between images (Image Jump Setting)
273
Help Guide
Sets the available number of when rating images with the key to which you have assigned [Rating] using [
Custom Key].
You can select the checked number when setting [Rating] using the custom key.
Related Topic
Rating
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
274
Help Guide
You can specify in advance on the memory card which still images you want to print out later. The (print order)
icon will appear on the specified images. DPOF refers to “Digital Print Order Format.”
DPOF setting will be retained after the image is printed. We recommend that you cancel this setting after printing.
Cancel All:
Clears all DPOF marks.
Print Setting:
Sets whether to print the date on images registered with DPOF marks.
The position or size of the date (inside or outside of the image) may differ depending on the printer.
Note
You cannot add the DPOF mark to the following files:
RAW images
275
Help Guide
You can delete an image displayed. Once you have deleted an image, you cannot restore it. Confirm the image to be
deleted beforehand.
Note
The protected images cannot be deleted.
Related Topic
Deleting multiple selected images (Delete)
276
Help Guide
You can delete multiple selected images. Once you have deleted an image, you cannot restore it. Confirm the image to
be deleted beforehand.
Hint
Perform [Format] to delete all images, including protected images.
To display the desired folder or date, select the desired folder or date during playback by performing the following procedure:
(Image Index) button → select the bar on the left using the control wheel → select the desired folder or date using the
top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
If you select a group in [Multiple Img.], all the images in the group will be deleted. To select and delete particular images within
the group, execute [Multiple Img.] while displaying the images within the group.
Note
The protected images cannot be deleted.
The menu items that can be selected vary according to the [View Mode] setting and the selected content.
Related Topic
Deleting a displayed image
Format
277
Help Guide
Delete confirm.
You can set whether [Delete] or [Cancel] is selected as a default on the delete confirmation screen.
278
Help Guide
To view images stored on this product using a TV, an HDMI cable (sold separately) and an HD TV equipped with an
HDMI jack are required.
2 Connect the HDMI micro terminal of this product to the HDMI jack of the TV using an HDMI cable (sold
separately).
“BRAVIA” Sync
By connecting this product to a TV that supports “BRAVIA” Sync using an HDMI cable (sold separately), you can operate
this product's playback functions with the TV remote control.
1. After performing the steps above to connect this camera to a TV, select MENU → (Setup) → [HDMI Settings] →
[CTRL FOR HDMI] → [On].
2. Press the SYNC MENU button on the TV remote control, and select the desired mode.
If you connect this camera to a TV using an HDMI cable, available menu items are limited.
Only TVs that support “BRAVIA” Sync can provide SYNC MENU operations. For details, refer to the operating
instructions supplied with the TV.
279
If the product performs unwanted operations in response to the TV remote control when the product is connected to
another manufacturer’s TV using an HDMI connection, select MENU → (Setup) → [HDMI Settings] → [CTRL
FOR HDMI] → [Off].
Hint
This product is compatible with the PhotoTV HD standard. If you connect Sony PhotoTV HD-compatible devices using an HDMI
cable (sold separately), the TV is set to the image quality suitable for viewing still images, and a whole new world of photos can
be enjoyed in breathtaking high quality.
You can connect this product to Sony PhotoTV HD-compatible devices with a USB terminal using the USB cable.
The PhotoTV HD allows for a highly-detailed, photo-like expression of subtle textures and colors.
For details, refer to the operating instructions supplied with the compatible TV.
Note
Do not connect this product and another device using the output terminals of both. Doing so may cause a malfunction.
Some devices may not work properly when connected to this product. For example, they may not output video or audio.
Use an HDMI cable with the HDMI logo or a genuine Sony cable.
Use an HDMI cable that is compatible with the HDMI micro terminal of the product and the HDMI jack of the TV.
When [ TC Output] is set to [On], the image may not be output properly to the TV or recording device. In such cases, set [
TC Output] to [Off].
If images do not appear on the TV screen properly, select MENU → (Setup) → [HDMI Settings] → [HDMI Resolution] →
[2160p/1080p], [1080p] or [1080i] according to the TV to be connected.
During HDMI output, when you switch the movie from 4K to HD image quality or vice-versa, or change the movie to a different
frame rate or different color mode, the screen may become dark. This is not a malfunction.
If you set [ File Format] to [XAVC S 4K] and shoot movies while the camera is connected to an HDMI device, images will not
be displayed on the monitor.
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to PAL, the screen may black out for an instant in the following situations. This is not a
malfunction.
When you start or stop recording movies while the shooting mode is set to a mode other than (Movie) or .
When you change the shooting mode from (Movie) or to another mode.
When you play back a movie for the first time after switching to the playback mode.
280
Help Guide
Allows you to register up to 2 often-used modes or product settings to the product and up to 4 (M1 through M4) to the
memory card. You can recall the settings using just the mode dial.
Note
M1 through M4 can be selected only when a memory card is inserted into the product.
When registering the settings on a memory card, only a memory card that has been selected using [ Select Media] can be
used.
Related Topic
Recall (Camera Settings1/Camera Settings2)
281
Help Guide
Selects the memory card slot from which settings are recalled or to which settings are registered for M1 through M4.
282
Help Guide
You can register shooting settings (such as exposure, focus setting, drive mode, etc.) to a custom key in advance and
temporarily recall them while holding down the key. Simply press the custom key to switch the settings quickly and
release the key to go back to the original settings. This function is useful when recording active scenes such as sports.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Reg Cust Shoot Set] → Select a registration number from [Recall
Custom hold 1] to [Recall Custom hold 3].
The setting screen for the selected number will be displayed.
2 Using the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel, select the check boxes for the functions that you
want to recall with one of the registration numbers and press the center to check each box.
3 Select the function that you want to adjust using the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel, and
press the center to adjust the function to the desired setting.
Select [Import Current Setting] to register the current settings of the camera to the registration number that you
chose.
4 Select [Register].
Note
The registration numbers [Recall Custom hold 1] through [Recall Custom hold 3] are available only when the shooting mode is
set to P/A/S/M.
Depending on the attached lens and the status of the camera when the registered setting recall is executed, the registered
settings may not take effect.
283
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
284
Help Guide
2 Select the key to which you want to assign the function on the selection screen, and press the center of the
control wheel.
The keys that can be assigned functions are different for [ Custom Key], [ Custom Key] and [
Custom Key].
1. AF-ON Button
2. Custom Button 3
3. Custom Button 2
4. Custom Button 1
5. AEL Button
6. Center Button
7. Control Wheel/Down Button/Left Button/Right Button
8. Custom Button 4
9. Multi-Slc Center Btn
10. Fn/ Button
You can also assign a shooting function to the focus hold button on the lens. However, some lenses do not have
a focus hold button.
Related Topic
Using the control wheel
Using the multi-selector
Focus Standard
286
Help Guide
You can assign the functions to be called up when you press the Fn (Function) button.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Function Menu Set.] → set a function to the desired location.
The functions that can be assigned are displayed on the setup item selection screen.
287
Help Guide
Dial Setup
Note
The [Dial Setup] function is enabled when the shooting mode is set to “M.”
288
Help Guide
Av/Tv Rotate
Sets the direction of rotation for the front dial, rear dial, or control wheel when changing the aperture value or shutter
speed.
289
Help Guide
Function Ring(Lens)
You can choose which of the following functions to assign to the function ring on the lens: power-assisted focusing
(power focus), or switching the angle of view between full frame and APS-C/Super 35 mm (available only with
compatible lenses).
This function can be used when the camera's system software (firmware) is Ver. 2.00 or later.
For details, refer to the operating instructions supplied with the lens.
Related Topic
APS-C/Super 35mm
Version
290
Help Guide
You can set whether the multi-selector, dials, and wheel can be locked by pressing and holding down the Fn (Function)
button.
To lock the operating parts, hold down the Fn (function) button until the message “Locked.” appears on the
monitor.
Hint
You can release the lock by holding the Fn (Function) button down again.
Note
If you set [ AF Area Regist.] to [On], [Lock Operation Parts] will be fixed to [Off].
Related Topic
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
291
Help Guide
Add Item
You can register the desired menu items to (My Menu) under MENU.
2 Select an item that you want to add to (My Menu) using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control
wheel.
Hint
You can add up to 30 items to (My Menu).
Note
You cannot add the following items to (My Menu).
Any item under MENU → (Playback)
[View on TV]
Related Topic
Sort Item
Delete Item
Using MENU items
292
Help Guide
Sort Item
You can rearrange the menu items added to (My Menu) under MENU.
2 Select an item that you want to move using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control wheel.
Related Topic
Add Item
293
Help Guide
Delete Item
2 Select an item that you want to delete using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control wheel, and then
press the center to delete the selected item.
Hint
To delete all the items on a page, select MENU → (My Menu) → [Delete Page].
You can delete all the items added to (My Menu) by selecting MENU → (My Menu) → [Delete All].
Related Topic
Delete Page
Delete All
Add Item
294
Help Guide
Delete Page
You can delete all the menu items added to a page under (My Menu) in MENU.
2 Select a page that you want to delete using the left/right sides of the control wheel, and then press the
center of the control wheel to delete the items.
Related Topic
Add Item
Delete All
295
Help Guide
Delete All
You can delete all the menu items added to (My Menu) in MENU.
2 Select [OK].
Related Topic
Add Item
Delete Page
296
Help Guide
Auto Review
You can check the recorded image on the screen right after the shooting. You can also set the display time for Auto
Review.
Note
When you use a function that performs image processing, the image before processing may be displayed temporarily, followed by
the image after processing.
The DISP (Display Setting) settings are applied for the Auto Review display.
Related Topic
Enlarging an image being played back (Enlarge Image)
297
Help Guide
Aperture Preview
While you press and hold the key to which you assigned the [Aperture Preview] function, the aperture is stepped down to
the set aperture value and you can check the blurriness prior to shooting.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → set the [Aperture Preview] function to the
desired key.
2 Confirm the image by pressing the key to which [Aperture Preview] was assigned.
Hint
Although you can change the aperture value during the preview, the subject may be defocused if you select a brighter aperture.
We recommend that you adjust the focus again.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Shot. Result Preview
298
Help Guide
While pressing down the key to which [Shot. Result Preview] is assigned, you can check the image preview with the
DRO, shutter speed, aperture and ISO sensitivity settings applied. Check the shooting result preview before shooting.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → set the [Shot. Result Preview] function to the
desired key.
2 Confirm the image by pressing the key to which [Shot. Result Preview] was assigned.
Hint
The DRO settings, shutter speed, aperture and ISO sensitivity settings you have set are reflected on the image for [Shot. Result
Preview], but some effects cannot be previewed depending on the shooting settings. Even in that case, the settings you have
selected will be applied to the images you shoot.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Aperture Preview
299
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to show images altered with effects of the exposure compensation, white balance, [Creative Style],
or [Picture Effect] on the screen.
Hint
When you use a third-party flash, such as a studio flash, Live View Display may be dark for some shutter speed settings. When
[Live View Display] is set to [Setting Effect OFF], Live View Display will be displayed brightly, so that you can easily check the
composition.
Note
[Live View Display] cannot be set to [Setting Effect OFF] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Movie]
[S&Q Motion]
[Scene Selection]
When [Live View Display] is set to [Setting Effect OFF], the brightness of the shot image will not be the same as that of the
displayed Live View.
300
Help Guide
Grid Line
Sets whether the grid line is displayed or not. The grid line will help you to adjust the composition of images.
301
Help Guide
FINDER/MONITOR
Sets the method for switching the display between Electronic Viewfinder and the screen.
Hint
You can assign the [FINDER/MONITOR] function to your preferred key.
MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key], [ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key] → set [Finder/Monitor Sel.] to
the preferred key.
If you want to retain the Electronic Viewfinder display or the monitor display, set [FINDER/MONITOR] to [Viewfinder(Manual)] or
[Monitor(Manual)] beforehand.
You can keep the monitor off when you take your eyes off the Electronic Viewfinder during recording by setting the monitor
display to [Monitor Off] using the DISP button. Select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [DISP Button] → [Monitor] and add
a check mark to [Monitor Off] beforehand.
Note
When the monitor is pulled out, the eye sensor of the camera will not detect your eye approaching even if [FINDER/MONITOR] is
set to [Auto]. The image will continue to be displayed on the monitor.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
DISP Button (Monitor/Finder)
302
Help Guide
Monitor Brightness
Note
The [Sunny Weather] setting is too bright for shooting indoors. Set [Monitor Brightness] to [Manual] for indoor shooting.
303
Help Guide
Viewfinder Bright.
When using an electronic viewfinder, this product adjusts the brightness of the electronic viewfinder according to the
surrounding environment.
304
Help Guide
305
Help Guide
Display Quality
Note
When [High] is set, battery consumption will be higher than when [Standard] is set.
When the temperature of the camera rises, the setting may become locked to [Standard].
306
Help Guide
Bright Monitoring
Allows you to adjust the composition when shooting in dark environments. By extending the exposure time, you can
check the composition on the viewfinder/monitor even in dark locations such as under the night sky.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → assign the [Bright Monitoring] function to the
desired key.
2 Press the key to which you assigned the [Bright Monitoring] function, then shoot an image.
The brightness due to [Bright Monitoring] will continue after shooting.
To return the monitor brightness to normal, press the key to which you assigned the [Bright Monitoring] function
once again.
Note
During [Bright Monitoring], [Live View Display] will automatically switch to [Setting Effect OFF], and setting values such as
exposure compensation will not be reflected in the live view display. It is recommended that you use [Bright Monitoring] only in
dark locations.
During [Bright Monitoring], the shutter speed may be slower than normal while shooting in dark locations. Also, because the
measured brightness range is expanded, the exposure may change.
Related Topic
Live View Display
307
Help Guide
Format
When you use a memory card with this camera for the first time, we recommend that you format the card using the
camera for stable performance of the memory card. Note that formatting permanently erases all data on the memory
card, and is unrecoverable. Save valuable data on a computer, etc.
Note
Formatting permanently erases all data including protected images and registered settings (from M1 to M4).
The access lamp lights up during formatting. Do not remove the memory card while the access lamp is lit up.
Format the memory card on this camera. If you format the memory card on the computer, the memory card may not be usable
depending on the format type.
It may take a few minutes to complete formatting, depending on the memory card.
You cannot format the memory card if the remaining battery charge is less than 1%.
308
Help Guide
File Number
Hint
The setting for [File Number] will be applied to both slot 1 and slot 2.
Even if you change the setting of [Prioritize Rec. Media], the file numbers will be sequential across the two memory cards in each
slot by setting [File Number] to [Series].
309
Help Guide
You can specify the first three characters of the file name for images you shoot.
2 Select the entry field for the file name to display a keyboard on the screen, and then enter three characters
of your choice.
The setting for [Set File Name] will be applied to both slot 1 and slot 2.
Note
Only capital letters, numbers, and underscores can be entered. However, an underscore cannot be used as the first character.
The three characters of the file name you specify using [Set File Name] will only be applied to images you shoot after changing
the setting.
Related Topic
How to use the keyboard
310
Help Guide
Displays the recordable time of movies for the inserted memory card. Also displays the number of recordable still images
for the inserted memory card.
311
Help Guide
Selects the memory card slot on which to record. [Slot 1] is the default setting. If you do not intend to change the settings
and will only use one memory card, use the slot 1.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] → [Prioritize Rec. Media] → desired slot.
Hint
To record the same image on two memory cards at the same time or to sort recorded images onto two memory card slots by the
image type (still image/movie), use [Recording Mode].
Note
The slot 2 supports Memory Stick PRO Duo media and SD cards. The slot 1 supports SD cards only.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
312
Help Guide
You can select the method for recording an image, such as recording the same image simultaneously to two memory
cards or recording different types of images to two memory cards.
Hint
Even when [Recording Mode] is set to [Sort(RAW/JPEG)] or [Sort(JPEG/RAW)], if [RAW & JPEG] is not selected under [ File
Format], only files of the selected format will be recorded.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
313
Help Guide
If a memory card in use becomes full or you have forgotten to insert a memory card into a slot, you can record images to
the other memory card.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] → [Auto Switch Media] → desired setting.
: Recording images
(A): Recording is no longer possible on the memory card (due to lack of capacity, etc.).
(B): The memory card is replaced with a recordable one.
The camera stops simultaneous recording when either of the memory cards becomes full. When you remove the
memory card that has become full, the camera starts recording to the other memory card.
When you replace the memory card that has become full with a recordable memory card, the camera starts
simultaneous recording with the selected setting again.
314
Example: When [Prioritize Rec. Media] is set to [Slot 1]
([Recording Mode]: [Simult. ( / )])
Images that are not recorded simultaneously (for example: still images during [Simult. ( )]) continue to be
recorded to the other memory card when the memory card in use becomes full.
When the memory card in use becomes full while recording a movie, the movie continues to be recorded to the other
memory card until the recording in progress is finished.
When recording images separately to two memory cards in the RAW and JPEG formats:
When [Recording Mode] is set to [Sort(RAW/JPEG)] or [Sort(JPEG/RAW)], and [ File Format] is set to [RAW &
JPEG]
The camera stops recording when either of the memory cards becomes full. When you remove the memory card that
has become full, the camera starts recording both in the RAW and JPEG formats to the other memory card.
When you replace the memory card that has become full with a recordable memory card, the camera starts recording
the two types of images separately with the selected setting again.
315
(C): A recordable memory card is inserted.
When the memory card in use becomes full while recording movies, the camera starts recording to the other memory
card.
When recording still images and movies separately to two memory cards:
When either of the memory cards becomes full, both still images and movies are recorded to the other memory card.
When you replace the memory card that has become full with a recordable memory card, the camera starts recording
the two types of images separately with the selected setting again.
Hint
Images are recorded to the memory card in the slot displayed on the monitor with an arrow symbol. After the camera switches
the slot using [Auto Switch Media], replace the memory card in the former slot with a recordable memory card.
If [Recording Mode] is set to [Standard], the setting for [Prioritize Rec. Media] will switch automatically when the slot switches. If
you want to record on the slot in use before switching, select the desired slot again using [Prioritize Rec. Media].
If you want to continually record with the settings selected with [Recording Mode] and [Prioritize Rec. Media], set [Auto Switch
Media] to [Off].
Even when the camera records a movie on two memory cards using [Auto Switch Media], the continuous recordable time is
approximately 29 minutes per recording.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Recordable movie times
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
316
Help Guide
If [Folder Name] is set to [Standard Form] and there are 2 folders or more, you can select the folder on the memory card
to which images are to be recorded.
Note
You cannot select the folder when [Folder Name] is set to [Date Form].
If [Recording Mode] is set to other than [Standard], you may only select the common folder on the both memory cards. If there is
no common folder, you can make one using [New Folder].
Related Topic
Folder Name
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
317
Help Guide
New Folder
Creates a new folder on the memory card for recording still images. A new folder is created with a folder number one
greater than the largest folder number currently used. Images are recorded in the newly created folder.
Note
When you insert a memory card that was used with other equipment into this product and shoot images, a new folder may be
automatically created.
Up to 4,000 images in total can be stored in one folder. When the folder capacity is exceeded, a new folder may be automatically
created.
If [Recording Mode] is set to other than [Standard], a new folder is created with a folder number one greater than the largest
folder number currently used on both memory cards inserted in the memory card slots.
If [Recording Mode] is set to other than [Standard] and an image is shot, a new folder may be automatically created.
Related Topic
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
318
Help Guide
Folder Name
Still images are recorded in a folder that is automatically created inside the DCIM folder on the memory card. You can
change the way folder names are assigned.
Note
You cannot change the [Folder Name] settings for movies.
319
Help Guide
Recover Image DB
If image files were processed on a computer, problems may occur in the image database file. In such cases, the images
on the memory card will not be played back on this product. If these problems happen, repair the file using [Recover
Image DB].
1 MENU → (Setup) → [Recover Image DB] → desired memory card slot → [Enter].
Note
Use a sufficiently charged battery pack. Low battery power during repairing can cause damage to data.
320
Help Guide
Audio signals
Note
If [Focus Mode] is set to [Continuous AF], the camera will not beep when it focuses on a subject.
321
Help Guide
Sets time intervals to automatically switch to power save mode when you are not performing operations to prevent
wearing down the battery pack. To return to shooting mode, perform an operation such as pressing the shutter button
halfway down.
Note
Turn off the product when you do not use it for a long time.
The power save function is not activated when power is being supplied via USB, when playing back slideshows, when recording
movies, or when connected to a computer or TV.
322
Help Guide
Sets the temperature of the camera at which the camera turns off automatically during shooting. When it is set to [High],
you can continue shooting even when the temperature of the camera gets hotter than normal.
Continuous recording time for movies when [Auto Pwr OFF Temp.] is set to [High]
The duration of time available for continuous movie recording is as follows when the camera starts recording with the
default settings after the power has been turned off for a while. The following values indicate the continuous time from
when the camera starts recording until the camera stops recording.
Note
Even if [Auto Pwr OFF Temp.] is set to [High], depending on the conditions or the temperature of the camera, the recordable time
for movies may not change.
Related Topic
Recordable movie times
323
Help Guide
IR Remote Ctrl
You can operate this product and shoot images using the SHUTTER button, 2SEC button (2 second delay shutter), and
START/STOP button (or Movie button (RMT-DSLR2 only)) on the Wireless Remote Commander RMT-DSLR1 (sold
separately) and RMT-DSLR2 (sold separately). Refer also to the operating instructions for the Infrared Remote
Commander.
Note
The lens or lens hood may block the infrared remote sensor that receive the signals. Use the infrared remote commander in the
position from which the signal can reach the product.
When [IR Remote Ctrl] is set to [On], the product does not switch to power save mode. Set [Off] after using an infrared remote
commander.
An infrared remote commander cannot be used while [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On].
324
Help Guide
NTSC/PAL Selector
Plays back movies recorded with the product on a NTSC/PAL system TV.
Note
If you insert a memory card that has previously been formatted with a different video system, a message telling you that you must
reformat the card will appear.
If you want to record using another system, re-format the memory card or use another memory card.
When you perform [NTSC/PAL Selector], and the setting is changed from the default one, a message "Running on NTSC." or
"Running on PAL." will appear on the start-up screen.
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to PAL, the viewfinder or monitor of the camera or the screen of an HDMI-connected device
may black out for an instant in the following situations. This is not a malfunction.
When you start or stop recording movies while the shooting mode is set to a mode other than (Movie) or .
When you change the shooting mode from (Movie) or to another mode.
When you play back a movie for the first time after switching to the playback mode.
325
Help Guide
When you connect the product to a High Definition (HD) TV with HDMI terminals using an HDMI cable (sold separately),
you can select HDMI Resolution to output images to the TV.
Note
If the images are not displayed properly using the [Auto] setting, select either [1080i], [1080p] or [2160p/1080p], based on which
TV is to be connected.
326
Help Guide
HDMI Settings: 24p/60p Output (movie) (Only for 1080 60i compatible models)
You can set 1080/24p or 1080/60p as the HDMI output format when [ Record Setting] is set to [24p 50M], [24p 60M]
or [24p 100M].
Note
Steps 1 and 2 can be set in either order.
Related Topic
Record Setting (movie)
327
Help Guide
Selects whether to display the shooting information when this product and the TV are connected using an HDMI cable
(sold separately).
Off:
Does not display the shooting information on the TV.
Only the recorded image is displayed on the TV, while the recorded image and the shooting information are displayed on
the camera’s monitor.
Note
When this product is connected to a 4K-compatible TV, [Off] is selected automatically.
If you set [ File Format] to [XAVC S 4K] and shoot movies while the camera is connected to an HDMI device, images will not
be displayed on the monitor.
328
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to layer the TC (time code) information on the output signal via the HDMI terminal when outputting
the signal to other professional-use devices.
This function layers the time code information on the HDMI output signal. The product sends the time code information
as digital data, not as an image displayed on the screen. The connected device can then refer to the digital data to
recognize the time data.
Note
When [ TC Output] is set to [On], the image may not be output properly to the TV or recording device. In such cases, set [
TC Output] to [Off].
329
Help Guide
If you connect the camera to an external recorder/player, you can remotely command the recorder/player to start/stop
recording using the camera.
Note
Available for external recorders/players compatible with [ REC Control].
When you use the [ REC Control] function, set the shooting mode to (Movie).
When [ TC Output] is set to [Off], you cannot use the [ REC Control] function.
Even when is displayed, the external recorder/player may not work properly depending on the settings or status of the
recorder/player. Check if the external recorder/player works properly before use.
330
Help Guide
When connecting this product to a “BRAVIA” Sync-compatible TV using an HDMI cable (sold separately), you can
operate this product by aiming the TV remote control at the TV.
Note
If you connect this product to a TV using an HDMI cable, available menu items are limited.
[CTRL FOR HDMI] is available only with a “BRAVIA” Sync-compatible TV. Also, the SYNC MENU operation differs depending on
the TV you are using. For details, refer to the operating instructions supplied with the TV.
If the product performs unwanted operations in response to the TV remote control when the product is connected to another
manufacturer’s TV using an HDMI connection, select MENU → (Setup) → [HDMI Settings] → [CTRL FOR HDMI] → [Off].
331
Help Guide
USB Connection
Selects the USB connection method when this product is connected to a computer, etc.
Select MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] → [Off] beforehand.
PC Remote:
Uses Imaging Edge to control the product from a computer, including such functions as shooting and storing images on
the computer.
Note
It may take some time to make the connection between this product and a computer when [USB Connection] is set to [Auto].
Related Topic
PC Remote Settings: Still Img. Save Dest.
PC Remote Settings: RAW+J PC Save Img
332
Help Guide
333
Help Guide
Sets whether to supply power via the USB cable when the product is connected to a computer or an USB device.
Note
Insert the battery pack into the product to supply power via USB cable.
334
Help Guide
Sets whether to save still images stored in both the camera and the computer during PC Remote shooting. This setting
is useful when you want to check recorded images on the camera without leaving the camera.
* PC Remote: Uses Imaging Edge to control the product from a computer, including such functions as shooting and storing images on the
computer.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [PC Remote Settings] → [Still Img. Save Dest.] → desired setting.
Note
During PC Remote shooting, you cannot change settings for [Still Img. Save Dest.]. Adjust the settings before you start shooting.
If you insert a memory card that is not recordable, you cannot shoot still images even if you select [PC+Camera].
If you select [PC+Camera] and you have not inserted a memory card into the camera, you cannot release the shutter even if
[Release w/o Card] is set to [Enable].
During PC Remote shooting, [Recording Mode] under [Rec. Media Settings] is locked to [Standard] and cannot be changed.
While you are playing back still images on the camera, you cannot shoot using PC Remote.
Related Topic
USB Connection
Release w/o Card
PC Remote Settings: RAW+J PC Save Img
335
Help Guide
Selects the file type for images to be transferred to the computer in PC Remote shooting.
When shooting still images using PC Remote, the application on the computer does not display the image until the
image has been completely transferred. When performing RAW+JPEG shooting, you can accelerate the display
processing speed by transferring only JPEG images instead of transferring both RAW and JPEG images.
* PC Remote: Uses Imaging Edge to control the product from a computer, including such functions as shooting and storing images on the
computer.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [PC Remote Settings] → [RAW+J PC Save Img] → desired setting.
Note
The setting for [RAW+J PC Save Img] cannot be changed during PC Remote shooting. Adjust the setting before shooting.
[RAW+J PC Save Img] can be set only when [ File Format] is set to [RAW & JPEG].
During PC Remote shooting, [Recording Mode] under [Rec. Media Settings] is locked to [Standard] and cannot be changed.
Related Topic
USB Connection
File Format (still image)
PC Remote Settings: Still Img. Save Dest.
336
Help Guide
Language
Selects the language to be used in the menu items, warnings and messages.
337
Help Guide
Date/Time Setup
The Clock Set screen is displayed automatically when you turn on this product for the first time or when the internal
rechargeable backup battery has fully discharged. Select this menu when setting the date and time after the first time.
Hint
To charge the internal rechargeable backup battery, insert a charged battery pack, and leave the product for 24 hours or more
with the power off.
If the clock resets every time the battery is charged, the internal rechargeable backup battery may be worn out. Consult your
service facility.
338
Help Guide
Area Setting
339
Help Guide
Copyright Info
2 When you select [Set Photographer] or [Set Copyright], a keyboard appears on the screen. Enter your
desired name.
Set Photographer:
Sets the photographer name.
Set Copyright:
Sets the copyright holder name.
Disp. Copyright Info:
Displays the current copyright information.
Note
You can only enter alphanumeric characters and symbols for [Set Photographer] and [Set Copyright]. You can enter up to 46
letters.
In order to prevent unauthorized use of [Copyright Info], be sure to clear the [Set Photographer] and [Set Copyright] columns
before lending out or handing over your camera.
Sony is not liable for problems or damages resulting from use of [Copyright Info].
Related Topic
How to use the keyboard
340
Help Guide
Version
Displays the version of this product’s software. Check the version when updates for this product’s software are released,
etc.
Also displays the version of the lens if a lens compatible with firmware updates is attached.
The version of the Mount Adaptor is displayed in the lens area if a Mount Adaptor compatible with firmware updates is
attached.
Note
Updating can be performed only when the battery level is (3 remaining battery bars) or more. Use a sufficiently charged
battery pack.
341
Help Guide
Demo Mode
The [Demo Mode] function displays the movies recorded on the memory card automatically (demonstration), when the
camera has not been operated for a certain time. Normally select [Off].
Note
You can set this item only when the product is powered by the AC Adaptor (supplied).
When there is no protected AVCHD movies on the memory card, you cannot select [On].
[Demo Mode] always displays movies on the memory card in memory card slot 1.
342
Help Guide
Setting Reset
Resets the product to the default settings. Even if you perform [Setting Reset], the recorded images are retained.
Note
Be sure not to eject the battery pack while resetting.
The value set with [AF Micro Adj.] will not be reset even when [Camera Settings Reset] or [Initialize] is performed.
Settings of [Picture Profile] will not be reset even when [Camera Settings Reset] or [Initialize] is performed.
Related Topic
AF Micro Adj.
List of default setting values
343
Help Guide
PlayMemories Mobile
Using the smartphone application PlayMemories Mobile, you can shoot an image while controlling the camera using a
smartphone or transfer the images recorded on the camera to the smartphone. Download and install the application
PlayMemories Mobile from your smartphone’s application store. If PlayMemories Mobile is already installed on your
smartphone, be sure to update it to the latest version.
For details on PlayMemories Mobile, refer to the support page (http://www.sony.net/pmm/).
The latest version of the smartphone application has been rebranded as Imaging Edge Mobile.
Note
Depending on future version upgrades, the operational procedures or screen displays are subject to change without notice.
344
Help Guide
You can connect this product to an NFC-enabled Android smartphone by touching them together and then operate the
product using the smartphone.
Make sure that [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] is set to [On] by selecting MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone].
The smartphone and the product are connected, and PlayMemories Mobile launches.
You can shoot an image by remote control while checking the composition of the image on the smartphone
screen.
Touch the smartphone to the product for 1-2 seconds until PlayMemories Mobile launches.
About “NFC”
NFC is a technology that enables short-range wireless communication between various devices, such as mobile phones
or IC tags, etc. NFC makes data communication simpler with just a touch on the designated touch-point.
NFC (Near Field Communication) is an international standard of short-range wireless communication technology.
Note
If you cannot make a connection, do as the following:
Launch PlayMemories Mobile on your smartphone, and then move the smartphone slowly toward the (N mark) of this
product.
If the smartphone is in a case, remove it.
If the product is in a case, remove it.
Check whether the NFC function is activated on your smartphone.
Radio wave interference may occur as Bluetooth communications and Wi-Fi communications use the same frequency band. If
your Wi-Fi connection is unstable, it may be improved by turning off the Bluetooth function of the smartphone. If you do this, the
location information link function is not available.
345
When [Airplane Mode] is set to [On], you cannot connect this product and the smartphone. Set [Airplane Mode] to [Off].
If this product and the smartphone are connected when the product is in playback mode, the displayed image is sent to the
smartphone.
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
Airplane Mode
346
Help Guide
You can control this product using your smartphone by connecting your smartphone to the camera using the QR code.
Make sure that [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] is set to [On] by selecting MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone].
QR code (A) and the SSID (B) are displayed on the monitor of this product.
2 Launch PlayMemories Mobile on your smartphone and select [Scan QR Code of the Camera].
4 Read the QR code displayed on the monitor of this product with the smartphone.
347
Once the QR code has been read, a message [Connect with the camera?] will be displayed on the smartphone
screen.
Hint
Once the QR code has been read, this product's SSID (DIRECT-xxxx) and password are registered to the smartphone. This
enables you to easily connect the smartphone to the product via Wi-Fi at a later date by selecting the SSID. (Set [Ctrl w/
Smartphone] to [On] in advance.)
Note
Radio wave interference may occur as Bluetooth communications and Wi-Fi communications use the same frequency band. If
your Wi-Fi connection is unstable, it may be improved by turning off the Bluetooth function of the smartphone. If you do this, the
location information link function is not available.
If you cannot connect your smartphone to this product using the [One-touch(NFC)] function or QR code, use the SSID and
password.
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (SSID)
348
Help Guide
You can control this product using your smartphone by connecting your smartphone to the camera using the SSID and
password.
Make sure that [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] is set to [On] by selecting MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone].
This product's SSID and password are displayed on the monitor of this product.
349
The smartphone is connected to the product.
You can now shoot images remotely while checking the composition on the smartphone screen.
Note
Radio wave interference may occur as Bluetooth communications and Wi-Fi communications use the same frequency band. If
your Wi-Fi connection is unstable, it may be improved by turning off the Bluetooth function of the smartphone. If you do this, the
location information link function is not available.
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
350
Help Guide
You can connect an iPhone or iPad to the camera using the QR code and operate the camera using the iPhone or iPad.
Make sure that [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] is set to [On] by selecting MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone].
QR code (A) and the SSID (B) are displayed on the monitor of this product.
2 Launch PlayMemories Mobile on your iPhone or iPad and select [Scan QR Code of the Camera].
4 Read the QR code displayed on the monitor of this product with the iPhone or iPad.
351
5 Install the profile (setting information) by following the instructions shown on the iPhone or iPad screen
and select [OK].
6 Select [Settings] on the "Home" screen → [Wi-Fi] → the SSID for this product on the iPhone or iPad.
7 Return to the "Home" screen of the iPhone or iPad and launch PlayMemories Mobile.
You can now shoot images remotely while checking the composition on the screen of your iPhone or iPad.
Hint
Once the QR code has been read, this product's SSID (DIRECT-xxxx) and password are registered to the iPhone or iPad. This
enables you to easily connect the iPhone or iPad to the product via Wi-Fi at a later date by selecting the SSID. (Set [Ctrl w/
Smartphone] to [On] in advance.)
352
Note
Radio wave interference may occur as Bluetooth communications and Wi-Fi communications use the same frequency band. If
your Wi-Fi connection is unstable, it may be improved by turning off the Bluetooth function of the smartphone. If you do this, the
location information link function is not available.
If you cannot connect your iPhone or iPad to this product using the QR code, use the SSID and password.
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (SSID)
353
Help Guide
You can control the camera using an iPhone or iPad by connecting the iPhone or iPad to the camera using the SSID and
password.
Make sure that [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] is set to [On] by selecting MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone].
This product's SSID and password are displayed on the monitor of this product.
3 Select the model name of this product (DIRECT-xxxx: xxxx) on the Wi-Fi setting screen of your iPhone or
iPad.
354
The iPhone or iPad is connected to the product.
5 Confirm that your iPhone or iPad was connected to the “SSID” shown on this product.
6 Return to the "Home" screen of the iPhone or iPad and launch PlayMemories Mobile.
You can now shoot images remotely while checking the composition on the screen of your iPhone or iPad.
Note
Radio wave interference may occur as Bluetooth communications and Wi-Fi communications use the same frequency band. If
your Wi-Fi connection is unstable, it may be improved by turning off the Bluetooth function of the smartphone. If you do this, the
location information link function is not available.
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
355
Help Guide
You can transfer still images, XAVC S movies, slow-motion movies, or quick-motion movies to a smartphone and view
them. The application PlayMemories Mobile must be installed on your smartphone.
If you press the (Send to Smartphone) button in playback mode, the setting screen for [Send to
Smartphone] will appear.
2 If the product is ready for the transfer, the information screen appears on the product. Connect the
smartphone and the product using that information.
The setting method for connecting the smartphone and the product varies depending on the smartphone.
The options displayed may differ depending on the View Mode selected on the camera.
(2) If you select [Multiple Images], select the desired images using the center of the control wheel, then press MENU →
[Enter].
Select on Smartphone:
Displays all images recorded on the product’s memory card on the smartphone.
Note
You can only transfer images that are saved on the camera's memory card.
You can only transfer images that are saved on the memory card in the memory card slot being played back. To change which
memory card slot is being played back, select MENU → (Playback) → [Select PB Media] → the desired slot.
You can select an image size to be sent to the smartphone from [Original], [2M] or [VGA].
To change the image size, refer to the following steps.
For Android smartphone
Start PlayMemories Mobile, and change the image size by [Settings] → [Copy Image Size].
For iPhone/iPad
Select PlayMemories Mobile in the setting menu, and change the image size by [Copy Image Size].
RAW images are converted to JPEG format when they are sent.
356
You cannot transfer XAVC S 4K movies or the original data of XAVC S HD movies recorded in [120p]/[100p] to a smartphone.
You can only transfer proxy movies.
Depending on the smartphone, the transferred movie may not be played back correctly. For example, the movie may not play
smoothly, or there may be no sound.
Depending on the format of the still image, movie, slow-motion movie, or quick-motion movie, it may not be possible to play it
back on a smartphone.
This product shares the connection information for [Send to Smartphone] with a device that has permission to connect. If you
want to change the device that is permitted to connect to the product, reset the connection information by following these steps.
MENU → (Network) → [Wi-Fi Settings] → [SSID/PW Reset]. After resetting the connection information, you must register the
smartphone again.
When [Airplane Mode] is set to [On], you cannot connect this product and the smartphone. Set [Airplane Mode] to [Off].
While you transfer many images or long movies, we recommend that you supply power to the camera from a wall outlet (wall
socket) using the AC Adaptor (supplied).
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (NFC One-touch remote)
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (QR code)
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (SSID)
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (QR code)
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (SSID)
Sending images to an Android smartphone (NFC One-touch Sharing)
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Sending Target (proxy movies)
Airplane Mode
357
Help Guide
When transferring XAVC S video to a smartphone with [Send to Smartphone], you can set whether to transfer the low-
bit-rate proxy movie or the high-bit-rate original movie.
Note
You cannot transfer XAVC S 4K movies or the original data of XAVC S HD movies recorded in [120p]/[100p] to a smartphone.
You can only transfer proxy movies.
While you transfer many images or long movies, we recommend that you supply power to the camera from a wall outlet (wall
socket) using the AC Adaptor (supplied).
Related Topic
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Proxy Recording
358
Help Guide
With just one touch, you can connect this product and an NFC-enabled Android smartphone, and send an image
displayed on the product screen directly to the smartphone. You can transfer still images, XAVC S movies and slow-
motion and quick-motion movies.
The product and the smartphone are connected, and PlayMemories Mobile automatically launches on the
smartphone, and then the displayed image is sent to the smartphone.
Before you touch the smartphone, cancel the sleep and lock-screen functions of the smartphone.
The NFC function is available only when the (N mark) is displayed on the product.
Touch the smartphone to the product for 1-2 seconds until PlayMemories Mobile launches.
To transfer two or more images, select MENU → (Network) → [Snd to Smrtphn Func] → [Send to
Smartphone] to select images. After the connection enabled screen appears, use NFC to connect the product
and the smartphone.
About “NFC”
NFC is a technology that enables short-range wireless communication between various devices, such as mobile phones
or IC tags, etc. NFC makes data communication simpler with just a touch on the designated touch-point.
NFC (Near Field Communication) is an international standard of short-range wireless communication technology.
Note
You can only transfer images that are saved on the memory card in the memory card slot being played back. To change the
memory card slot to be played back, select MENU → (Playback) → [Select PB Media] → the desired slot.
You can select an image size to be sent to the smartphone from [Original], [2M] or [VGA].
To change the image size, refer to the following steps.
Start PlayMemories Mobile, and change the image size by [Settings] → [Copy Image Size].
359
RAW images are converted to JPEG format when they are sent.
You cannot transfer XAVC S 4K movies or the original data of XAVC S HD movies recorded in [120p]/[100p] to a smartphone.
You can only transfer proxy movies.
Depending on the smartphone, the transferred movie may not be played back correctly. For example, the movie may not play
smoothly, or there may be no sound.
If the Image Index is displayed on the product, you cannot transfer images using the NFC function.
When [Airplane Mode] is set to [On], you cannot connect the product and the smartphone. Set [Airplane Mode] to [Off].
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Sending Target (proxy movies)
Airplane Mode
360
Help Guide
Send to Computer
You can transfer images stored in the product to a computer connected to a wireless access point or wireless broadband
router and easily make backup copies using this operation. Before starting this operation, install PlayMemories Home on
your computer and register the access point on the product.
Note
Depending on the application settings of your computer, the product will turn off after saving the images to your computer.
You can transfer images from the product to only one computer at a time.
If you want to transfer images to another computer, connect the product and the computer via a USB connection and follow the
instructions in PlayMemories Home.
Related Topic
Installing PlayMemories Home
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
361
Help Guide
You can set up image transferring using an FTP server or transfer images to the FTP server. Basic knowledge of FTP
servers is required.
For details, refer to the “FTP Help Guide.”
https://rd1.sony.net/help/di/ftp/h_zz/
Related Topic
Importing root certification to the camera (Imp Root Certificate)
362
Help Guide
View on TV
You can view images on a network-enabled TV by transferring them from the product without connecting the product and
TV with a cable. For some TVs, you may need to perform operations on the TV. For details, refer to the operating
instructions supplied with the TV.
2 When you want to play back images using slideshow, press the center of the control wheel.
To display the next/previous image manually, press the right/left sides of the control wheel.
To change the device to be connected, press the down side of the control wheel, then select [Device list].
Slideshow settings
You can change the slideshow settings by pressing the down side of the control wheel.
Playback Selection:
Selects the group of images to be shown.
Folder View(Still):
Selects from [All] and [All in Folder].
Date View:
Selects from [All] and [All with this date].
Interval:
Selects from [Short] and [Long].
Effects*:
Selects from [On] and [Off].
Playback Image Size:
Selects from [HD] and [4K].
* The settings are effective only for BRAVIA TV which is compatible with the functions.
Note
You can only transfer images that are saved on the memory card in the memory card slot being played back. To change the
memory card slot to be played back, select MENU → (Playback) → [Select PB Media] → the desired slot.
You can view images on a Wi-Fi Direct-enabled TV or network-enabled TV (including wired network-enabled TVs).
If you connect TV and this product and do not use Wi-Fi Direct, you need to register your access point first.
Movies cannot be shown on a TV via Wi-Fi. Use an HDMI cable (sold separately).
363
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
364
Help Guide
You can use the application PlayMemories Mobile to obtain location information from a smartphone that is connected
with your camera using Bluetooth communication. You can record the obtained location information when shooting
images.
Preparation in advance
To use the location information linking function of the camera, the application PlayMemories Mobile is required.
If “Location Information Linkage” is not displayed on the top page of PlayMemories Mobile, you need to perform the
following steps beforehand.
You can install PlayMemories Mobile from the application store of your smartphone. If you have already installed
the application, update it to the latest version.
2. Transfer a pre-recorded image to your smartphone using the [Send to Smartphone] function of the camera.
After you transfer an image recorded using the camera to your smartphone, “Location Information Linkage” will
appear on the top page of the application.
Operating procedure
: Operations performed on the smartphone
: Operations performed on the camera
Do not perform the Bluetooth pairing operation on the smartphone setting screen. In steps 2 to 7, the pairing
operation is performed using the camera and the application PlayMemories Mobile.
If you accidentally perform the pairing operation on the smartphone setting screen in step 1, cancel the pairing
and then perform the pairing operation by following Steps 2 through 7 using the camera and the application
PlayMemories Mobile.
2. : On the camera, select MENU → (Network) → [Bluetooth Settings] → [Bluetooth Function] → [On].
4. : Launch PlayMemories Mobile on your smartphone and tap “Location Information Linkage.”
If “Location Information Linkage” is not displayed, follow the steps in “Preparation in advance” above.
5. : Activate [Location Information Linkage] on the [Location Information Linkage] setting screen of PlayMemories
Mobile.
6. : Follow the instructions on the [Location Information Linkage] setting screen of PlayMemories Mobile, and then
select your camera from the list.
365
8. : On the camera, select MENU → (Network) → [ Loc. Info. Link Set.] → [Location Info. Link] → [On].
(obtaining location information icon) will be displayed on the monitor of the camera. Location information
obtained by your smartphone using GPS, etc., will be recorded when shooting images.
Hint
Location information can be linked when PlayMemories Mobile is running on your smartphone even if the smartphone monitor is
off. However, if the camera has been turned off for a while, location information may not be linked immediately when you turn the
camera back on. In this case, location information will be linked immediately if you open the PlayMemories Mobile screen on the
smartphone.
When PlayMemories Mobile is not operating, such as when the smartphone is restarted, launch PlayMemories Mobile to resume
location information linking.
If the location information linking function does not work properly, see the following notes and perform pairing again.
Confirm that the Bluetooth function of your smartphone is activated.
Confirm that the camera is not connected with other devices using the Bluetooth function.
Confirm that [Airplane Mode] for the camera is set to [Off].
Delete the pairing information for the camera registered in PlayMemories Mobile.
Execute [Reset Network Set.] of the camera.
Note
When you initialize the camera, the pairing information is also deleted. To perform pairing again, delete the pairing information for
the camera registered in PlayMemories Mobile before trying again.
The location information will not be recorded when it cannot be obtained, such as when the Bluetooth connection is
disconnected.
The camera can be paired with up to 15 Bluetooth devices, but can link the location information with that of only one smartphone.
If you want to link the location information with that of another smartphone, turn off the [Location Information Linkage] function of
the smartphone that is already linked.
If the Bluetooth connection is unstable, remove any obstacles, such as people or metal objects from between the camera and the
paired smartphone.
When pairing the camera and your smartphone, be sure to use the [Location Information Linkage] menu on PlayMemories
Mobile.
To use the location information linkage function, set [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] to [Off].
Supported smartphones
Android smartphones: Android 5.0 or later and compatible with Bluetooth 4.0 or later*
Related Topic
PlayMemories Home
PlayMemories Mobile
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Bluetooth Settings
Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl
367
Help Guide
You can operate the camera using a Bluetooth remote commander RMT-P1BT (sold separately). Select MENU →
(Network) → [Bluetooth Settings] → [Bluetooth Function] → [On] in advance. Refer to the instruction manual for the
Bluetooth remote commander as well.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
If there is no Bluetooth device currently paired with the camera, the screen for pairing as described in Step 2 will
appear.
2 On the camera, select MENU → (Network) → [Bluetooth Settings] → [Pairing] to display the screen for
pairing.
For details, refer to the instruction manual for the Bluetooth remote commander.
4 On the camera, select [OK] on the confirmation screen for the Bluetooth connection.
Pairing is complete, and you can now operate the camera from the Bluetooth remote commander. After pairing
the device once, you can connect the camera and the Bluetooth remote commander again in the future by
setting [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] to [On].
Hint
The Bluetooth connection is only active while you are operating the camera using the Bluetooth remote commander.
If the function does not work properly, check the following notes and then try pairing again.
Confirm that the camera is not connected with other devices using the Bluetooth function.
Confirm that [Airplane Mode] for the camera is set to [Off].
Execute [Reset Network Set.] of the camera.
Note
When you initialize the camera, the pairing information is also deleted. To use the Bluetooth remote commander, perform pairing
again.
If the Bluetooth connection is unstable, remove any obstacles, such as people or metal objects from between the camera and the
paired Bluetooth remote commander.
You cannot use the function for linking location information with a smartphone while [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On].
You cannot use an infrared remote commander while [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On].
368
While [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On], the camera will not switch to the power-saving mode. Change the setting to [Off] when
you are done using the Bluetooth remote commander.
Related Topic
Bluetooth Settings
Version
369
Help Guide
Airplane Mode
When you board an airplane, etc., you can temporarily disable all the wireless-related functions including Wi-Fi.
If you set [Airplane Mode] to [On], an airplane mark will be displayed on the screen.
370
Help Guide
If your access point has a Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) button, you can register the access point to this product easily.
2 Push the Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) button on the access point to connect.
Note
[WPS Push] works only if the security setting of your access point is set to WPA or WPA2 and your access point supports the Wi-
Fi Protected Setup (WPS) button method. If the security setting is set to WEP or your access point does not support the Wi-Fi
Protected Setup (WPS) button method, perform [Access Point Set.].
For details about the available functions and settings of your access point, see the access point operating instructions or contact
the administrator of the access point.
A connection may not be possible or the communication distance may be shorter depending on the surrounding conditions, such
as the type of wall material and the presence of obstructions or radio waves between the product and access point. In this case,
change the location of the product or move the product closer to the access point.
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
371
Help Guide
You can register your access point manually. Before starting the procedure, check the SSID name of the access point,
security system, and password. The password may be preset in some devices. For details, see the access point
operating instructions, or consult the access point administrator.
When the desired access point is displayed on the screen: Select the desired access point.
When the desired access point is not displayed on the screen: Select [Manual Setting] and set the access
point.
If you select [Manual Setting], input the SSID name of the access point, then select the security system.
4 Select [OK].
WPS PIN:
Displays the PIN code you enter into the connected device.
Priority Connection:
Select [On] or [Off].
IP Address Setting:
372
Select [Auto] or [Manual].
IP Address:
If you are entering the IP address manually, enter the set address.
Subnet Mask/Default Gateway/Primary DNS Server/Second DNS Server:
If you have set [IP Address Setting] to [Manual], enter each address according to your network environment.
Note
To give the registered access point priority in the future, set [Priority Connection] to [On].
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
How to use the keyboard
373
Help Guide
374
Help Guide
This product shares the connection information for [Send to Smartphone] and [ Connection] with a device that has
permission to connect. If you want to change the device that is permitted to connect, reset the connection information.
Note
If you connect this product to a smartphone after resetting the connection information, you must make the settings for the
smartphone again.
Related Topic
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Ctrl w/ Smartphone
375
Help Guide
You can change the device name for the Wi-Fi Direct or Bluetooth connection.
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
How to use the keyboard
376
Help Guide
Imports a root certificate needed to verify a server from a memory card. Use this function for encrypted communications
during FTP transfer.
For details, refer to the “FTP Help Guide.”
http://rd1.sony.net/help/di/ftp/h_zz/
377
Help Guide
378
Help Guide
You can confirm the operating computer environment of the software from the following URL:
http://www.sony.net/pcenv/
379
Help Guide
PlayMemories Home
You can import images shot with this product to your computer.
You can play back the images imported to your computer.
You can share your images using PlayMemories Online.
You can edit movies such as by cutting or merging.
You can add various effects such as BGM and subtitles to movies.
You can organize images on the computer on a calendar by shooting date to view them.
You can edit and correct images, such as by trimming and resizing.
You can create a disc from movies imported to a computer.
Blu-ray discs or AVCHD discs can be created from XAVC S-format movies.
For other details, please refer to the Help of PlayMemories Home.
Related Topic
Installing PlayMemories Home
380
Help Guide
1 Using your computer's Internet browser, go to the URL below and download PlayMemories Home by
following the on-screen instructions.
http://www.sony.net/pm/
An Internet connection is required.
For detailed instructions, visit the PlayMemories Home support page (English only).
http://www.sony.co.jp/pmh-se/
2 Connect the product to your computer using the USB cable, then turn the product on.
New functions may be added to PlayMemories Home. Even if PlayMemories Home has already been installed
on your computer, connect this product and your computer again.
Do not remove the USB cable from the camera while the camera is in operation or the access screen is
displayed. Doing so may damage the data.
Note
Log on as Administrator.
It may be necessary to restart your computer. When the restart confirmation message appears, restart the computer following the
instructions on the screen.
381
Help Guide
Connecting to a computer
4 Connect the camera to the computer using the USB cable (A).
When you connect the camera to the computer for the first time, the procedure for recognizing the camera may
start automatically on the computer. Wait until the procedure is finished.
If you connect the product to your computer using the USB cable when [USB Power Supply] is set to [On],
power is supplied from your computer. (Default setting: [On])
Use a USB 3.1-compatible computer and the USB Type-C cable (sold separately) for higher-speed
communications.
Note
Do not turn on/off or restart the computer, or wake the computer from sleep mode when a USB connection has been established
between the computer and the camera. Doing so may cause a malfunction. Before turning on/off or restarting the computer, or
waking the computer from sleep mode, disconnect the camera from the computer.
Related Topic
USB Connection
USB LUN Setting
382
Help Guide
PlayMemories Home allows you to easily import images. For details on PlayMemories Home functions, see the Help of
PlayMemories Home.
Importing images to the computer without using PlayMemories Home (For Windows)
When the AutoPlay Wizard appears after making a USB connection between this product and a computer, click [Open
folder to view files] → [OK] → [DCIM]. Then copy the desired images to the computer.
Importing images to the computer without using PlayMemories Home (For Mac)
Connect the product to your Mac computer. Double-click the newly recognized icon on the desktop → the folder in which
the image you want to import is stored. Then drag and drop the image file on to the hard disk icon.
Note
For operations such as importing XAVC S movies or AVCHD movies to the computer, use PlayMemories Home.
Do not edit or otherwise process AVCHD or XAVC S movie files/folders from the connected computer. Movie files may be
damaged or become unplayable. Do not delete or copy AVCHD movies or XAVC S movies on the memory card from the
computer. Sony is not held liable for consequences resulting from such operations via the computer.
383
Help Guide
Note
On Mac computers, drag and drop the memory card icon or the drive icon into the “Trash” icon. The camera will be disconnected
from the computer.
On Windows 7/Windows 8 computers, the disconnection icon may not appear. In that case, you can skip the steps above.
Do not remove the USB cable from the camera while the access lamp is lit. The data may be damaged.
384
Help Guide
Imaging Edge
Imaging Edge is a software suite that includes functions such as remote shooting from a computer, and adjusting or
developing RAW images recorded with the camera.
Viewer:
You can display and search images.
Edit:
You can edit images with various corrections such as tone curve and sharpness, and develop images recorded in RAW
format.
Remote:
You can adjust the camera settings or shoot images from a computer connected to the camera with a USB cable.
To control the camera using a computer, select MENU → (Setup) → [USB Connection] → [PC Remote] before
connecting the camera to the computer with a USB cable.
For details on how to use Imaging Edge, refer to the support page.
http://www.sony.net/disoft/help/
Related Topic
USB Connection
385
Help Guide
You can create a disc that can be played back on other devices from a movie recorded on this camera.
What devices can play back the disc depends on the disc type. Select a disc type suitable for the playback devices you
will be using.
Depending on the movie type, the movie format may be converted when creating a disc.
Hint
You can use the following types of 12 cm discs with PlayMemories Home.
BD-R/DVD-R/DVD+R/DVD+R DL: Non-rewritable
BD-RE/DVD-RW/DVD+RW: Rewritable
Additional recording is not possible.
Always maintain your “PlayStation 3” to use the latest version of the “PlayStation 3” system software.
Note
4K movies cannot be recorded on a disc in 4K image quality.
Related Topic
Creating Blu-ray Discs from high-definition image quality movies
Creating DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) from high-definition image quality movies
386
Creating DVD discs from standard image quality movies
387
Help Guide
You can create Blu-ray Discs that can be played back on Blu-ray Disc playback devices (such as Sony Blu-ray Disc
players or the PlayStation 3, etc.).
Note
When creating Blu-ray discs using PlayMemories Home from movies recorded in the XAVC S movie format, the image quality is
converted to 1920×1080 (60i/50i). It is not possible to create discs with the original image quality.
To record movies with the original image quality, copy movies to a computer or an external medium.
Related Topic
Selecting a disc to be created
Creating DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) from high-definition image quality movies
Creating DVD discs from standard image quality movies
388
Help Guide
Creating DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) from high-definition image quality
movies
You can create DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) that can be played back on AVCHD-compatible playback devices
(such as Sony Blu-ray Disc players or the PlayStation 3, etc.).
Note
When creating DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) using PlayMemories Home from movies recorded in the XAVC S movie
format, the image quality is converted to 1920×1080 (60i/50i). It is not possible to create discs with the original image quality.
To record movies with the original image quality, copy movies to a computer or an external medium.
When creating AVCHD recording discs using PlayMemories Home from movies recorded in the AVCHD movie format with [
Record Setting] set to [60i 24M(FX)]/[50i 24M(FX)], the image quality is converted and it is not possible to create discs with the
original image quality.
This conversion can take a long time. To record movies with the original image quality, use a Blu-ray Disc.
Related Topic
Selecting a disc to be created
Creating Blu-ray Discs from high-definition image quality movies
Creating DVD discs from standard image quality movies
389
Help Guide
You can create DVD discs that can be played back on ordinary DVD playback devices (DVD players, computers that can
play back DVD discs, etc.).
Related Topic
Selecting a disc to be created
Creating Blu-ray Discs from high-definition image quality movies
Creating DVD discs (AVCHD recording discs) from high-definition image quality movies
390
Help Guide
You can change settings related to all the camera operations including shooting, playback, and operating method. You
can also execute camera functions from the MENU.
2 Select the desired setting you want to adjust using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control wheel or by
turning the control wheel, and then press the center of the control wheel.
Select an icon at the top of the screen (A) and press the left/right side of the control wheel to move to another
MENU tab.
You can move to the next MENU tab by pressing the Fn button. (This function can be used when the camera’s
system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.)
You can go back to the previous screen by pressing the MENU button (B).
3 Select the desired setting value, and press the center to confirm your selection.
Hint
You can display the menu screen by assigning the [MENU] function to a custom key using [ Custom Key] or [ Custom
Key], and then pressing that key. (This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.)
391
Related Topic
Add Item
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Version
392
Help Guide
You can set whether RAW images are compressed or uncompressed using [ RAW File Type].
Note
If you do not intend to edit the images on your computer, we recommend that you record in JPEG format.
You cannot add DPOF (print order) registration marks to RAW images.
Related Topic
JPEG Image Size (still image)
RAW File Type (still image)
393
Help Guide
Note
When [Uncompressed] is selected for [ RAW File Type], the icon on the screen switches to . is also displayed
while an image shot in uncompressed RAW format is played back.
394
Help Guide
Selects the JPEG image quality when [ File Format] is set to [RAW & JPEG] or [JPEG].
Related Topic
File Format (still image)
395
Help Guide
The larger the image size, the more detail will be reproduced when the image is printed on large-format paper. The
smaller the image size, the more images can be recorded.
Note
When [ File Format] is set to [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG], the image size for RAW images corresponds to “L.”
Related Topic
396
Aspect Ratio (still image)
397
Help Guide
398
Help Guide
APS-C/Super 35mm
Sets whether to record in APS-C-equivalent size for still images and in Super 35mm-equivalent size for movies. You can
use an APS-C-size dedicated lens with this product by recording in an APS-C-equivalent size or Super 35 mm-
equivalent size.
Note
If you try to perform full-frame shooting with an APS-C-compatible lens attached, you may not achieve the desired shooting
results.
When APS-C/Super 35 mm shooting is activated, the central part of the image sensor is used and the angle of view is equivalent
to that of an APS-C-size image sensor.
399
Help Guide
When you set the shutter speed to 1 second(s) or longer (long exposure shooting), noise reduction is turned on for the
duration that the shutter is open. With the function turned on, the grainy noise typical of long exposures is reduced.
Note
Noise reduction may not be activated even if [ Long Exposure NR] is set to [On] in the following situations:
The shooting mode is set to [Scene Selection] and [Sports Action] is selected.
[ Long Exposure NR] cannot be set to [Off] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
Depending on the shooting conditions, the camera may not perform noise reduction, even if the shutter speed is 1 second(s) or
longer.
400
Help Guide
When shooting with high ISO sensitivity, the product reduces noise that becomes more noticeable when the product
sensitivity is high.
Note
[ High ISO NR] is not available in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
[ High ISO NR] does not work for RAW images when the [ File Format] is [RAW & JPEG].
401
Help Guide
The way colors are represented using combinations of numbers or the range of color reproduction is called “color
space.” You can change the color space depending on the purpose of the image.
Note
[AdobeRGB] is for applications or printers that support color management and DCF2.0 option color space. Images may not be
printed or viewed in the correct colors if you use applications or printers that do not support Adobe RGB.
When displaying images that were recorded with [AdobeRGB] on non-Adobe RGB-compliant devices, the images will be
displayed with low saturation.
402
Help Guide
Lens Comp.
Compensates for shading in the corners of the screen or distortion of the screen, or reduces color deviation at the
corners of the screen caused by certain lens characteristics.
Note
This function is only available when using an automatic compensation compliant lens.
Darkness in the corners of the screen may not be corrected with [Shading Comp.], depending on the lens type.
Depending on the attached lens, [Distortion Comp.] is fixed to [Auto], and you cannot select [Off].
403
Help Guide
Scene Selection
Sports Action:
Shoots a moving subject at a fast shutter speed so that the subject looks as if it is standing still. The product shoots
images continuously while the shutter button is pressed.
Macro:
Shoots close-ups of the subjects, such as flowers, insects, food, or small items.
Landscape:
Shoots the entire range of a scenery in sharp focus with vivid colors.
Sunset:
Shoots the red of the sunset beautifully.
404
Night Scene:
Shoots night scenes without losing the dark atmosphere.
Night Portrait:
Shoots night scene portraits using the flash (sold separately).
Hint
To change the scene, rotate the front dial on the shooting screen and select a new scene.
Note
Under the following settings, the shutter speed is slower, so use of a tripod, etc. is recommended to prevent the image from
blurring:
[Night Scene]
[Night Portrait]
The minimum distance that you can come close to a subject does not change even if you select [Macro]. For the minimum in-
focus range, refer to the minimum distance of the lens attached to the product.
Related Topic
Using flash (sold separately)
405
Help Guide
Drive Mode
Select the appropriate mode for the subject, such as single shooting, continuous shooting or bracketing shooting.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
2 Select the desired mode using the right/left side of the control wheel.
Note
When the shooting mode is set to [Scene Selection] and [Sports Action] is selected, [Single Shooting] cannot be performed.
Related Topic
Cont. Shooting
Self-timer
Self-timer(Cont)
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
WB bracket
DRO Bracket
406
407
Help Guide
Bracket Settings
You can set the self-timer in bracket shooting mode, and the shooting order for exposure bracketing and white balance
bracketing.
1 Select / (Drive Mode) of the control wheel → select bracket shooting mode.
You can also set the drive mode by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Drive Mode].
Related Topic
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
WB bracket
DRO Bracket
408
Help Guide
Allows you to shoot an image after recalling often-used modes or camera settings registered with [ /
Memory] in advance.
Hint
To recall settings registered to the memory card, set the mode dial to 1, 2 (Memory recall), then select the desired number by
pressing the left/right side of the control wheel.
If you recall settings registered to the memory card, the settings are recalled from the memory card in the slot specified in [
Select Media]. You can confirm the memory card slot by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Select Media].
Settings registered to a memory card using another camera of the same model name can be recalled with this camera.
Note
If you set [ / Recall] after completing the shooting settings, the registered settings are given priority and the
original settings may become invalid. Check the indicators on the screen before shooting.
Related Topic
Memory (Camera Settings1/Camera Settings2)
409
Help Guide
Allows you to register up to 2 often-used modes or product settings to the product and up to 4 (M1 through M4) to the
memory card. You can recall the settings using just the mode dial.
Note
M1 through M4 can be selected only when a memory card is inserted into the product.
When registering the settings on a memory card, only a memory card that has been selected using [ Select Media] can be
used.
Related Topic
Recall (Camera Settings1/Camera Settings2)
410
Help Guide
Selects the memory card slot from which settings are recalled or to which settings are registered for M1 through M4.
411
Help Guide
You can register shooting settings (such as exposure, focus setting, drive mode, etc.) to a custom key in advance and
temporarily recall them while holding down the key. Simply press the custom key to switch the settings quickly and
release the key to go back to the original settings. This function is useful when recording active scenes such as sports.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Reg Cust Shoot Set] → Select a registration number from [Recall
Custom hold 1] to [Recall Custom hold 3].
The setting screen for the selected number will be displayed.
2 Using the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel, select the check boxes for the functions that you
want to recall with one of the registration numbers and press the center to check each box.
3 Select the function that you want to adjust using the top/bottom/left/right side of the control wheel, and
press the center to adjust the function to the desired setting.
Select [Import Current Setting] to register the current settings of the camera to the registration number that you
chose.
4 Select [Register].
Note
The registration numbers [Recall Custom hold 1] through [Recall Custom hold 3] are available only when the shooting mode is
set to P/A/S/M.
Depending on the attached lens and the status of the camera when the registered setting recall is executed, the registered
settings may not take effect.
412
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
413
Help Guide
You can automatically shoot a series of still images with the shooting interval and number of shots that you set in
advance (Interval shooting). You can then create a movie from the still images produced by interval shooting using the
computer software Imaging Edge. You cannot create a movie from the still images on the camera.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
2 MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Intvl. Shoot. Func.] → Select the item you want to set and the
desired setting.
When the time set for [Shooting Start Time] has elapsed, shooting will start.
When the number of shots set for [Number of Shots] is completed, the camera will return to the standby screen
for interval shooting.
Hint
If you press the shutter button during interval shooting, interval shooting will end and the camera will return to the standby screen
for interval shooting.
To go back to the normal shooting mode, select MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Intvl. Shoot. Func.] → [Interval
Shooting] → [Off].
If you press a key to which one of the following functions has been assigned at the moment when shooting starts, the function will
remain active during interval shooting even without you holding down the button.
[AEL hold]
[ AEL hold]
414
[AF/MF Control Hold]
[Regist. AF Area hold]
Still images shot with interval shooting are displayed as a group on the playback screen.
Still images shot with interval shooting can be played back continuously on the camera. If you intend to create a movie using the
still images, you can preview the result.
Note
You may not be able to record the set number of images depending on the remaining battery level and the amount of free space
on the recording medium. Supply power via USB while shooting, and use a memory card with sufficient space.
During interval shooting (including the time between pressing the shutter button and the start of shooting), you cannot perform
MENU operations, but you can perform dial operations. You can perform MENU operations until you press the shutter button.
[Silent Shoot. in Intvl.] is set to [On] in the default settings, regardless of the setting for [ Silent Shooting].
Related Topic
Imaging Edge
Version
415
Help Guide
Focus Mode
Focus indicator
(lit):
The subject is in focus and the focus is locked.
(flashing):
The subject is not in focus.
(lit):
The subject is in focus. The focus will be adjusted continuously according to the movements of the subject.
(lit):
Focusing is in progress.
Hint
In [Continuous AF] mode, you can lock the focus by pressing and holding the button that has been assigned the [Focus Hold]
function.
When you set the focus to infinity in the manual focus mode or the direct manual focus mode, make sure that the focus is on a
sufficiently distant subject by checking the monitor or the viewfinder.
416
Note
[Automatic AF] is available only when you are using a lens that supports phase detection AF.
When [Continuous AF] or [Automatic AF] is set, the angle of view may change little by little while focusing. This does not affect
the actual recorded images.
Only [Continuous AF] and [Manual Focus] are available when shooting movies or when the mode dial is set to .
Related Topic
Direct manual focus (DMF)
Manual Focus
MF Assist (still image)
Phase detection AF
417
Help Guide
Sets whether to release the shutter even if the subject is not in focus when [Focus Mode] is set to [Single-shot AF],
[DMF] or [Automatic AF] and the subject is remaining still.
Related Topic
Focus Mode
Priority Set in AF-C
418
Help Guide
Sets whether to release the shutter even if the subject is not in focus when the continuous AF is activated and the
subject is in motion.
Related Topic
Focus Mode
Priority Set in AF-S
419
Help Guide
Focus Area
Selects the focusing area. Use this function when it is difficult to focus properly in the auto focus mode.
420
When [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Zone], the focusing frame may switch between “When focusing on a larger
area” and “When focusing on a smaller area” depending on the subject or situation.
When you attach an A-mount lens with a Mount Adaptor (LA-EA1 or LA-EA3) (sold separately) and [ AF System]
is set to [Phase Detection AF], the focusing frame for “When focusing on a smaller area” may be displayed.
When focus is achieved automatically based on the whole range of the monitor
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, the [Focus Area] setting is disabled and the focusing
frame is shown by the dotted line. The AF operates with priority on and around the center area.
Hint
In the default settings, [Focus Area] is assigned to the C2 button.
Note
[Focus Area] is locked to [Wide] in the following situations:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
The focus area may not light up during continuous shooting or when the shutter button is pressed all the way down at once.
When the mode dial is set to (Movie) or or during movie shooting, [Lock-on AF] cannot be selected as the [Focus
Area].
When [Subject Detection] under [Face/Eye AF Set.] is set to [Animal], [Lock-on AF] cannot be selected as the [Focus Area].
Related Topic
Touch Operation
421
Adjusting the focus area settings to the camera’s orientation (horizontal/vertical) (Swt. V/H AF Area)
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
422
Help Guide
Focus Settings
Configures the focus functions using the front dial/rear dial or the control wheel.
When the focus mode is set to auto focus or Direct Manual Focus
You can adjust the focus area settings and the position of the focusing frame. The focusing frame can be moved only
when the [Focus Area] is set to the following:
[Zone]
[Flexible Spot]
[Expand Flexible Spot]
423
Help Guide
You can set whether to switch the [Focus Area] and the position of the focusing frame according to the orientation of the
camera (horizontal/vertical). This function is useful when shooting scenes for which you have to change the camera
position frequently, such as portraits or sports scenes.
Three camera orientations are detected: horizontal, vertical with the side of the shutter button facing up, and vertical
with the side of the shutter button facing down.
Note
If the setting for [ Swt. V/H AF Area] is changed, the focus settings for each camera orientation will not be retained.
The [Focus Area] and the position of the focusing frame will not change even when [ Swt. V/H AF Area] is set to [AF Point +
AF Area] or [AF Point Only] in the following situations:
When the shooting mode is set to [Intelligent Auto], [Movie], or [S&Q Motion]
While the shutter button is pressed halfway down
During movie shooting
While using the digital zoom function
While the auto-focusing is activated
When [Focus Settings] are activated
During continuous shooting
During the countdown for the self-timer
When [Focus Magnifier] is activated
424
When you shoot images right after the power is turned on and the camera is vertical, the first shot is taken with the horizontal
focus setting or with the last focus setting.
The orientation of the camera cannot be detected when the lens is facing up or down.
Related Topic
Focus Area
425
Help Guide
The AF illuminator supplies fill light to focus more easily on a subject in dark surroundings. In the time between pressing
the shutter button halfway down and locking the focus, the red AF illuminator lights up to allow the camera to focus
easily.
Note
You cannot use [ AF Illuminator] in the following situations:
When the shooting mode is [Movie] or [S&Q Motion].
When [ Focus Mode] is set to [Continuous AF] or [Automatic AF] and the subject is moving (when the focus indicator or
lights up).
When [Focus Magnifier] is activated.
When [Scene Selection] is set to the following modes:
[Landscape]
[Sports Action]
[Night Scene]
If the Multi Interface Shoe is equipped with a flash with an AF illuminator function, when the flash is turned on, the AF illuminator
will turn on as well.
The AF illuminator emits a very bright light. Although there is no health hazard, do not look directly into the AF illuminator at close
range.
426
Help Guide
Center Lock-on AF
When you press the center of the control wheel, the camera detects the subject positioned in the center of the screen
and continues to track the subject.
2 Align the target frame (A) over the subject and press the center of the control wheel.
Press the center again to stop tracking.
Hint
If you assign the [Focus Standard] function to the key of your choice, you can activate [Center Lock-on AF] or detect a subject
again by pressing the key when [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Center].
You can select the subject to be tracked by touch operation when shooting using the monitor. Set [Touch Operation] to [On], and
select [Touch Panel+Pad] or [Touch Panel Only] under [Touch Panel/Pad].
Note
The [Center Lock-on AF] function may not function very well in the following situations:
The subject is moving too quickly.
The subject is too small, or too large.
The contrast between the subject and the background is poor.
It is dark.
The ambient light changes.
Related Topic
427
Focus Standard
428
Help Guide
Face/Eye AF Set.
This function is used to determine whether or not the camera will focus with priority on faces or eyes.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
429
[Eye AF] by custom key
The Eye AF function can also be used by assigning [Eye AF] to a custom key. The camera can focus on eyes as long as
you are pressing the key. This is useful when you want to temporarily apply the Eye AF function to the entire screen
regardless of the setting for [Focus Area].
For instance, if [Focus Area] is set to [Flexible Spot] and you want the camera to focus on an eye outside of the focusing
frame, you can apply the Eye AF function by pressing the custom key to which [Eye AF] has been assigned, without
changing [Focus Area].
1. MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key] → desired key, then assign the [Eye AF] function to the
key.
2. MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Face/Eye AF Set.] → [Subject Detection] → desired setting.
3. Point the camera at the face of a human or animal, and press the key to which you have assigned the [Eye AF]
function.
4. Press the shutter button while pressing the key.
Hint
If you want the face or eye detection frame to disappear within a certain period of time after the camera has focused on the face
or eye, set [AF Area Auto Clear] to [On].
To detect animal eyes, arrange the composition so that both eyes and the nose of the animal are within the angle of view.
Note
When [Subject Detection] is set to [Human], the eyes of animals are not detected. When [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal],
human faces are not detected.
When the shooting mode is set to [Portrait] under [Scene Selection], [Face/Eye Prty in AF] is locked to [On] and [Subject
Detection] is locked to [Human].
When [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal], the following functions are unavailable.
[Lock-on AF]
[Center Lock-on AF]
[Face Prty in Mlti Mtr]
[Regist. Faces Priority]
The [Eye AF] function may not function very well in the following situations:
When the person is wearing sunglasses.
When the front hair covers the person’s eyes.
In low-light or back-lit conditions.
When the eyes are closed.
When the subject is in the shade.
When the subject is out of focus.
When the subject is moving too much.
If the subject is moving too much, the detection frame may not be displayed correctly over their eyes.
When the camera cannot focus on human eyes, it will detect and focus on the face instead. The camera cannot focus on eyes
when no human faces are detected.
430
The product may not detect faces at all or may accidentally detect other objects as faces in some conditions.
The Eye AF function is unavailable when the mode dial is set to (Movie) or , or during movie shooting.
The eye detection frame is not displayed when the Eye AF function is unavailable.
You cannot use the face/eye detection function with the following functions:
Zoom functions other than the optical zoom.
[Posterization] under [Picture Effect]
Focus Magnifier
When [Scene Selection] is set to [Landscape], [Night Scene], or [Sunset]
When [ Frame Rate] is set to [120fps]/[100fps] during slow-motion/quick-motion shooting.
You cannot use the face detection function in the following situation:
Movie shooting with [ Record Setting] set to [120p]/[100p]
Even if [Face Dtct Frame Dsp] is set to [Off], a green focusing frame will be displayed over faces that are in focus.
When the shooting mode is set to [Intelligent Auto], [Face/Eye Prty in AF] is locked to [On].
Even when [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal], the eyes of some types of animals cannot be detected.
Even when [Animal Eye Display] is set to [Off], a green focusing frame is displayed over eyes that are in focus.
Related Topic
Focus Mode
Focus Area
AF Area Auto Clear
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Version
431
Help Guide
You can select the AF track sensitivity when the subject goes out of focus in still image mode.
432
Help Guide
Sets the focus detection system (Phase Detection AF/Contrast AF) when you attach an A-mount lens using an LA-
EA1/LA-EA3 Mount Adaptor (sold separately).
Note
When [ AF System] is set to [Contrast AF], [Continuous AF] under [Focus Mode] is unavailable.
The following functions are unavailable when [ AF System] is set to [Phase Detection AF]:
[Zone], [Expand Flexible Spot], and [Lock-on AF] in [Focus Area] (All types of focus area are available when the camera's
system software (firmware) version is 2.00 or later.)
[Center Lock-on AF]
When [ AF System] is set to [Phase Detection AF], [Priority Set in AF-S] will temporarily switch to [AF] even if it is set to
[Balanced Emphasis].
433
Help Guide
You can reduce the sound from the aperture drive when shooting using a compatible lens.
This function can be used when the camera's system software (firmware) is Ver. 2.00 or later.
Note
When [Silent Priority] is selected, the focusing speed may become slower, and it may be more difficult to focus on a subject.
[Aperture Drive in AF] is unavailable when using a lens incompatible with this function.
Related Topic
Version
434
Help Guide
Selects whether to focus automatically when you press the shutter button halfway down. Select [Off] to adjust the focus
and the exposure separately.
Related Topic
AF On
Eye-Start AF (still image)
Pre-AF (still image)
Focus Magnifier
435
Help Guide
The product automatically adjusts focus before you press the shutter button halfway down. During focusing operations,
the screen may shake.
Note
[ Pre-AF] is available only when an E-mount lens is mounted.
436
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to use autofocus when you look through an Electronic Viewfinder.
Hint
[ Eye-Start AF] is available when an A-mount lens and a Mount Adaptor (LA-EA2, LA-EA4) (sold separately) are attached.
437
Help Guide
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
You can move the focusing frame to a preassigned position temporarily using a custom key. This function is useful when
shooting scenes in which the subject’s movements are predictable; for example, sports scenes. With this function, you
can switch the focus area quickly according to the situation.
If you assign [Regist AF Area tggle] to a custom key, you can use the registered focusing frame without holding down the key.
If [Reg. AF Area+AF On] is assigned to a custom key, auto focusing using the registered focusing frame is performed when the
key is pressed.
Note
A focus area cannot be registered in the following situations:
The mode dial is set to either (Movie) or
While [Touch Focus] is being performed
While using the digital zoom function
While [Lock-on AF] is being performed
While focusing
While performing focus lock
You cannot assign [Regist. AF Area hold] to [Left Button], [Right Button], or [Down Button].
You cannot call up the registered focus area in the following situations:
The mode dial is set to either (Auto Mode), (Movie) or
When [ AF Area Regist.] is set to [On], the [Lock Operation Parts] setting is locked to [Off].
Related Topic
Focus Area
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
438
Help Guide
Deletes the focusing frame position that was registered using [ AF Area Regist.].
Related Topic
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
439
Help Guide
Sets whether the focus area should be displayed all the time or should disappear automatically shortly after focus is
achieved.
440
Help Guide
You can set whether or not to display the area that is in focus when [Focus Area] is set to [Wide] or [Zone], in
[Continuous AF] mode.
Note
When [Focus Area] is set to one of the following, the focusing frames in the area that is in focus turn green:
[Center]
[Flexible Spot]
[Expand Flexible Spot]
When an A-mount lens and a Mount Adaptor (LA-EA1/LA-EA3) (sold separately) are mounted on the camera and [ AF
System] is set to [Phase Detection AF], [Disp. cont. AF area] is always turned on regardless of the [Focus Area] settings.
441
Help Guide
AF Micro Adj.
Allows you to adjust the auto-focusing position and register an adjusted value for each lens when using A-mount lenses
with an LA-EA2 or LA-EA4 Mount Adaptor (sold separately).
Use this function only when adjustments are needed. Note that the auto focus function may not be performed at a proper
position when using this adjustment.
Hint
It is recommended that you adjust the position under actual shooting conditions. Set [Focus Area] to [Flexible Spot] and use a
bright subject with high contrast when you adjust.
Note
When you attach a lens for which you have already registered a value, the registered value appears on the screen. [±0] appears
for lenses for which a value has not yet been registered.
If [-] is displayed as the value, then a total of 30 lenses have been registered and no new lens can be registered. To register a
new lens, attach a lens for which the registration can be erased, and set its value to [±0], or reset the values of all the lenses
using [Clear].
The [AF Micro Adj.] supports Sony, Minolta, or Konica-Minolta lenses. If you perform [AF Micro Adj.] with lenses other than the
supported lenses, the registered settings for the supported lenses may be affected. Do not perform [AF Micro Adj.] with an
unsupported lens.
You cannot set [AF Micro Adj.] individually for a Sony, Minolta, and Konica-Minolta lens of the same specification.
442
Help Guide
Exposure Comp.
Normally, exposure is set automatically (auto exposure). Based on the exposure value set by auto exposure, you can
make the entire image brighter or darker if you adjust [Exposure Comp.] to the plus side or minus side, respectively
(exposure compensation).
+ (over) side:
Images become brighter.
- (under) side:
Images become darker.
You can adjust the exposure compensation value within the range of -3.0 EV to +3.0 EV.
You can confirm the exposure compensation value that you set on the shooting screen.
Monitor
Viewfinder
443
To set the exposure compensation value using the MENU
You can adjust the exposure compensation value within a range of -5.0 EV to +5.0 EV when the exposure compensation
dial is set to “0.”
MENU→ (Camera Settings1) → [Exposure Comp.] → desired setting.
Note
You cannot perform the exposure compensation in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
When using [Manual Exposure], you can perform the exposure compensation only when [ISO] is set to [ISO AUTO].
The settings of the exposure compensation dial will be prioritized over [Exposure Comp.] or [Dial Ev Comp] in MENU.
Only a value between -3.0 EV and +3.0 EV with the equivalent image brightness appears on the screen when shooting. If you set
an exposure compensation value outside this range, the image brightness on the screen will not be affected, but the value will be
reflected in the recorded image.
You can adjust the exposure compensation value within the range of -2.0 EV to +2.0 EV for movies.
If you shoot a subject in extremely bright or dark conditions, or when you use the flash, you may not be able to get a satisfactory
effect.
When you set the exposure compensation dial to “0” from a setting other than “0,” the exposure value switches to “0” regardless
of the [Exposure Comp.] setting.
Related Topic
Exposure step
Dial Ev Comp
Exp.comp.set
Cont. Bracket
Single Bracket
Zebra Setting
444
Help Guide
Reset EV Comp.
Sets whether to maintain the exposure value set using [Exposure Comp.] when you turn off the power when the
exposure compensation dial position is set to “0.”
445
Help Guide
ISO
Sensitivity to light is expressed by the ISO number (recommended exposure index). The larger the number, the higher
the sensitivity.
You can change the value by 1/3 EV steps by turning the front dial as well as by turning the control wheel. You
can change the value by 1 EV steps by turning the rear dial.
Hint
You can change the range of ISO sensitivity that is set automatically in [ISO AUTO] mode. Select [ISO AUTO] and press the right
side of the control wheel, and set the desired values for [ISO AUTO Maximum] and [ISO AUTO Minimum].
Note
[ISO AUTO] is selected when using the following functions:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
When the ISO sensitivity is set to a value lower than ISO 100, the range for recordable subject brightness (dynamic range) may
decrease.
The higher the ISO value, the more noise will appear on the images.
The available ISO settings will differ depending on whether you are shooting still images, shooting movies, or shooting slow-
motion/quick-motion movies.
When shooting movies, ISO values between 100 and 102400 are available. If the ISO value is set to a value larger than 102400,
the setting is automatically switched to 102400. When you finish recording the movie, the ISO value returns to the original setting.
When shooting movies, ISO values between 100 and 102400 are available. If the ISO value is set to a value smaller than 100,
the setting is automatically switched to 100. When you finish recording the movie, the ISO value returns to the original setting.
When you select [ISO AUTO] with the shooting mode set to [P], [A], [S] or [M], the ISO sensitivity will be automatically adjusted
within the set range.
446
Help Guide
If you select [ISO AUTO] when the shooting mode is P (Program Auto) or A (Aperture Priority), you can set the shutter
speed at which the ISO sensitivity starts changing.
This function is effective for shooting moving subjects. You can minimize subject blurring while also preventing camera
shake.
Hint
The difference in shutter speed at which ISO sensitivity starts to change between [Faster], [Fast], [Standard], [Slow], and [Slower]
is 1 EV.
Note
If the exposure is insufficient even when the ISO sensitivity is set to [ISO AUTO Maximum] in [ISO AUTO], in order to shoot with
an appropriate exposure, the shutter speed will be slower than the speed set in [ISO AUTO Min. SS].
In the following situations, the shutter speed may not function as set:
When using the flash to shoot bright scenes. (The maximum shutter speed is limited to the flash-syncing speed of 1/250
second.)
When using the flash to shoot dark scenes with the [Flash Mode] set to [Fill-flash]. (The minimum shutter speed is limited to the
speed automatically determined by the camera.)
Related Topic
Program Auto
Aperture Priority
ISO
447
Help Guide
Metering Mode
Selects the metering mode that sets which part of the screen to measure for determining the exposure.
Hint
When [Spot] is selected and [Focus Area] is set to either [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot] while [Spot Metering Point] is
set to [Focus Point Link], the spot metering point can be coordinated with the focus area.
When [Multi] is selected and [Face Prty in Mlti Mtr] is set to [On], the camera measures brightness based on detected faces.
When [Metering Mode] is set to [Highlight] and the [D-Range Opt.] or [Auto HDR] function is activated, the brightness and the
contrast will be corrected automatically by dividing the image into small areas and analyzing the contrast of light and shadow.
Make settings based on the shooting circumstances.
Note
[Metering Mode] is locked to [Multi] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
Other zoom functions than the optical zoom
In [Highlight] mode, the subject may be dark if a brighter part exists on the screen.
Related Topic
AE lock
Spot Metering Point
Face Prty in Mlti Mtr
D-Range Opt. (DRO)
448
Auto HDR
449
Help Guide
Sets whether the camera measures brightness based on detected faces when [Metering Mode] is set to [Multi].
Note
When the shooting mode is set to [Intelligent Auto], [Face Prty in Mlti Mtr] is locked to [On].
When [Face/Eye Prty in AF] is set to [On] and [Subject Detection] is set to [Animal] under [Face/Eye AF Set.], [Face Prty in Mlti
Mtr] does not work.
Related Topic
Metering Mode
450
Help Guide
Sets whether to coordinate the spot metering position with the focus area when [Focus Area] is set to [Flexible Spot] or
[Expand Flexible Spot].
Note
When [Focus Area] is set to other than [Flexible Spot] or [Expand Flexible Spot], the spot metering position is locked to the
center.
When [Focus Area] is set to [Lock-on AF: Flexible Spot] or [Lock-on AF:Expand Flexible Spot], the spot metering position
coordinates to the Lock-on AF start position, but does not coordinate with the tracking of the subject.
Related Topic
Focus Area
Metering Mode
451
Help Guide
Exposure step
You can adjust the setting increment for the shutter speed, aperture, and exposure compensation values.
452
Help Guide
Sets whether to fix the exposure when you press the shutter button halfway down.
Select [Off] to adjust the focus and the exposure separately.
Note
Operation using the AEL button is prioritized over the [ AEL w/ shutter] settings.
453
Help Guide
Adjusts this camera's standard for the correct exposure value for each metering mode.
Metering Mode
The set standard value will be applied when you select the corresponding metering mode in MENU → (Camera
Settings1) → [Metering Mode].
Multi/ Center/ Spot/ Entire Screen Avg./ Highlight
Note
The exposure compensation will not be affected when [Exposure Std. Adjust] is changed.
The exposure value will be locked according to the value set for [ Spot] during using spot AEL.
The standard value for M.M (Metered Manual) will be changed according to the value set in [Exposure Std. Adjust].
The value set in [Exposure Std. Adjust] is recorded in Exif data separately from the exposure compensation value. The amount of
exposure standard value will not be added to the exposure compensation value.
If you set [Exposure Std. Adjust] during bracketing shooting, the number of shots for the bracketing will be reset.
Related Topic
Metering Mode
454
Help Guide
Flash Mode
Note
The default setting depends on the shooting mode.
Some [Flash Mode] settings are not available, depending on the shooting mode.
Related Topic
Using flash (sold separately)
Wireless Flash
455
Help Guide
Flash Comp.
Adjusts the amount of flash light in a range of –3.0 EV to +3.0 EV. Flash compensation changes the amount of flash light
only. Exposure compensation changes the amount of flash light along with the change of the shutter speed and aperture.
Selecting higher values (+ side) makes the flash level higher, and lower values (- side) makes the flash level
lower.
Note
[Flash Comp.] does not work when the shooting mode is set to the following modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
The higher flash effect (+ side) may not be visible due to the limited amount of flash light available, if the subject is outside the
maximum range of the flash. If the subject is very close, the lower flash effect (- side) may not be visible.
If you attach an ND filter to the lens or attach a diffuser or a color filter to the flash, the appropriate exposure may not be achieved
and images may turn out dark. In this case, adjust [Flash Comp.] to the desired value.
Related Topic
Using flash (sold separately)
456
Help Guide
Exp.comp.set
Sets whether to apply the exposure compensation value to control both flash light and ambient light, or just ambient light.
Related Topic
Flash Comp.
457
Help Guide
Wireless Flash
There are two methods for wireless flash shooting: light-signal flash shooting that uses the light of the flash attached to
the camera as a signal light, and radio-signal flash shooting that uses wireless communication. To perform radio-signal
flash shooting, use a compatible flash or the Wireless Radio Commander (sold separately). For details on how to set
each method, refer to the instruction manual of the flash or the Wireless Radio Commander.
1 Remove the shoe cap from the camera, and then attach the flash or the Wireless Radio Commander.
When performing wireless flash shooting with a flash attached, set the attached flash as the controller.
3 Set up an off-camera flash that is set to wireless mode, or that is attached to the Wireless Radio Receiver
(sold separately).
Note
The off-camera flash may emit light after receiving a light signal from a flash used as the controller of another camera. If this
occurs, change the channel of your flash. For details on how to change the channel, refer to the instruction manual for the flash.
For the flash that is compatible with wireless flash shooting, visit the Sony website, or consult your Sony dealer or local
authorized Sony service facility.
458
Help Guide
When using the flash, it is fired two or more times before shooting to reduce the red-eye phenomenon.
Note
Red Eye Reduction may not produce the desired effects. It depends on individual differences and conditions, such as distance to
the subject, or whether the subject looks at the pre-strobe or not.
459
Help Guide
You can configure the settings of a flash (sold separately) attached to the camera using the monitor and control wheel of
the camera.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.10 or later. Also, update the software
of your flash to the latest version before using this function.
For details on flash functions, refer to the instruction manual for the flash.
1 Attach the flash (sold separately) to the Multi Interface Shoe of the camera, and then turn on the camera
and the flash.
Hint
If you assign the [Ext. Flash Firing Set.] function to a key in advance by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [
Custom Key], you can call up the [Ext. Flash Firing Set.] screen simply by pressing that key.
You can adjust settings by operating the flash even while you are using [External Flash Set.].
You can also configure the settings for a Wireless Radio Commander (sold separately) attached to the camera.
Note
You can only use [External Flash Set.] to configure the settings of a flash (sold separately) or Wireless Radio Commander (sold
separately) manufactured by Sony and attached to the Multi Interface Shoe of the camera.
You can only use [External Flash Set.] when the flash is attached directly to the camera. You cannot use this function when
shooting with an off-camera flash that is connected using a cable.
Only some of the functions of the attached flash are configurable using [External Flash Set.]. You cannot perform pairing with
other flashes, reset the flash, initialize the flash, etc. via [External Flash Set.].
Also, [External Flash Set.] may be unavailable depending on the state of the flash.
For details on flashes and Wireless Radio Commanders that are compatible with this function, refer to the following support page.
https://www.sony.net/dics/7m3/
Related Topic
460
Version
461
Help Guide
White Balance
Corrects the tone effect of the ambient light condition to record a neutral white subject in white. Use this function when
the color tones of the image did not come out as you expected, or when you want to change the color tones on purpose
for photographic expression.
Hint
You can display the fine adjustment screen and perform fine adjustments of the color tones as required by pressing the right side
of the control wheel.
If the color tones do not come out as you expected in the selected settings, perform [WB bracket] shooting.
Note
[White Balance] is fixed to [Auto] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
If you use a mercury lamp or a sodium lamp as a light source, the accurate white balance will not be obtained because of the
characteristics of the light. It is recommended to shoot images using a flash or select [Custom Setup].
Related Topic
Capturing a basic white color in [Custom Setup] mode
Priority Set in AWB
WB bracket
462
Help Guide
Selects which tone to prioritize when shooting under lighting conditions such as incandescent light when [White Balance]
is set to [Auto].
Related Topic
White Balance
463
Help Guide
By dividing the image into small areas, the product analyzes the contrast of light and shadow between the subject and
the background, and creates an image with the optimal brightness and gradation.
2 Select the desired setting using the left/right sides of the control wheel.
Note
In the following situations, [D-Range Opt.] is fixed to [Off]:
When [Picture Effect] is set to other than [Off]
When [Picture Profile] is set to other than [Off]
[DRO/Auto HDR] is fixed to [Off] when the following modes are selected in [Scene Selection].
[Sunset]
[Night Scene]
[Night Portrait]
The setting is fixed to [D-Range Optimizer: Auto] when [Scene Selection] modes other than the above modes are selected.
When shooting with [D-Range Opt.], the image may be noisy. Select the proper level by checking the recorded image, especially
when you enhance the effect.
464
Help Guide
Auto HDR
Shoots three images using different exposures and combines the images with correct exposure, the bright parts of an
underexposed image, and the dark parts of an overexposed image to create images with a greater range of gradation
(High Dynamic Range). One image with proper exposure and one overlaid image are recorded.
2 Select the desired setting using the left/right sides of the control wheel.
Hint
The shutter is released three times for one shot. Be careful about the following:
Use this function when the subject is motionless or does not flash light.
Do not change the composition before shooting.
Note
This function is not available when the [ File Format] is [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG].
You cannot start the next shot until the capture process is completed after you shoot.
You may not obtain the desired effect depending on the luminance difference of a subject and the shooting conditions.
When the contrast of the scene is low or when product shake or subject blur occurs, you may not obtain good HDR images.
will be displayed over the recorded image to inform you when the camera detects image blurring. Change the
composition or re-shoot the image carefully to avoid image blur, as needed.
465
Help Guide
Creative Style
Allows you to set the desired image processing and finely adjust contrast, saturation and sharpness for each image
style. You can adjust exposure (shutter speed and aperture) as you like with this function, unlike with [Scene Selection],
where the product adjusts the exposure.
2 Select the desired style or [Style Box] using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
3 To adjust (Contrast), (Saturation) and (Sharpness), select the desired item using the right/left
sides, and then select the value using the top/bottom sides.
4 When selecting [Style Box], move to the right side using the right side of the control wheel, and then select
the desired style.
You can call up the same style with slightly different settings.
Contrast:
The higher the value selected, the more the difference of light and shadow is accentuated, and the bigger the effect on
the image.
Saturation:
The higher the value selected, the more vivid the color. When a lower value is selected, the color of the image is
restrained and subdued.
Sharpness:
Adjusts the sharpness. The higher the value selected, the more the contours are accentuated, and the lower the value
selected, the more the contours are softened.
Note
[Creative Style] is fixed to [Standard] in the following situations:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Scene Selection]
[Picture Effect] is set to other than [Off].
[Picture Profile] is set to other than [Off].
When this function is set to [Black & White] or [Sepia], [Saturation] cannot be adjusted.
467
Help Guide
Picture Effect
Select the desired effect filter to achieve more impressive and artistic images.
Hint
You can perform detailed settings for some items using the left/right sides of the control wheel.
Note
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, setting the zoom scale larger makes [Toy Camera] less effective.
When [Partial Color] is selected, images may not retain the selected color, depending on the subject or shooting conditions.
You cannot check the following effects on the shooting screen, because the product processes the image after the shot. Also, you
cannot shoot another image until image processing is finished. You cannot use these effects with movies.
[Rich-tone Mono.]
In the case of [Rich-tone Mono.], the shutter is released three times for one shot. Be careful about the following:
Use this function when the subject is motionless or does not flash light.
Do not change the composition during shooting.
When the contrast of the scene is low or when significant camera-shake or subject blur has occurred, you may not be able to
obtain good HDR images. If the product detects such a situation, appear on the recorded image to inform you of this
situation. Change the composition or re-shoot the image carefully to avoid image blur, as needed.
When [ File Format] is set to [RAW] or [RAW & JPEG], this function is not available.
468
4-732-947-15(1) Copyright 2018 Sony Corporation
469
Help Guide
Picture Profile
Allows you to change the settings for the color, gradation, etc. For details on “Picture Profile,” refer to
http://helpguide.sony.net/di/pp/v1/en/index.html.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Picture Profile] → the profile you want to change.
2 Move to the item index screen by pressing the right side of the control wheel.
3 Select the item to change using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
4 Select the desired value using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel and press in the center.
The default settings [PP1] through [PP10] for movies have been set in advance in the camera based on various shooting
conditions.
MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Picture Profile] → desired setting.
PP1:
Example setting using [Movie] gamma.
PP2:
Example setting using [Still] gamma.
PP3:
Example setting of natural color tone using the [ITU709] gamma.
PP4:
Example setting of a color tone faithful to the ITU709 standard.
PP5:
Example setting using [Cine1] gamma.
PP6:
Example setting using [Cine2] gamma.
PP7:
Example setting using [S-Log2] gamma.
PP8:
Example setting using the [S-Log3] gamma and the [S-Gamut3.Cine] under [Color Mode].
PP9:
Example setting using the [S-Log3] gamma and the [S-Gamut3] under [Color Mode].
PP10:
Example setting for recording HDR movies using [HLG2] gamma.
Black Level
Sets the black level. (–15 to +15)
Gamma
Selects a gamma curve.
Movie: Standard gamma curve for movies
Still: Standard gamma curve for still images
Cine1: Softens the contrast in dark parts and emphasizes gradation in bright parts to produce a relaxed color movie.
(equivalent to HG4609G33)
Cine2: Similar to [Cine1] but optimized for editing with up to 100% video signal. (equivalent to HG4600G30)
Cine3: Intensifies the contrast in light and shade more than [Cine1] and strengthens gradation in black.
Cine4: Strengthens the contrast in dark parts more than [Cine3].
ITU709: Gamma curve that corresponds to ITU709.
ITU709(800%): Gamma curve for confirming scenes on the assumption of shooting using [S-Log2] or [S-Log3].
S-Log2: Gamma curve for [S-Log2]. This setting is based on the assumption that the picture will be processed after
shooting.
S-Log3: Gamma curve for [S-Log3] with more similar features to film. This setting is based on the assumption that the
picture will be processed after shooting.
HLG: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Equivalent to the HDR standard Hybrid Log-Gamma, ITU-R BT.2100.
HLG1: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Emphasizes noise reduction. However, shooting is restricted to a narrower
dynamic range than with [HLG2] or [HLG3].
HLG2: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Provides a balance of dynamic range and noise reduction.
HLG3: Gamma curve for HDR recording. Wider dynamic range than [HLG2]. However, noise may increase.
[HLG1], [HLG2], and [HLG3] all apply a gamma curve with the same characteristics, but each offers a different
balance between dynamic range and noise reduction. Each has a different maximum video output level, as follows:
[HLG1]: approx. 87%, [HLG2]: approx. 95%, [HLG3]: approx. 100%.
Black Gamma
Corrects gamma in low intensity areas.
[Black Gamma] is fixed at “0” and cannot be adjusted when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3].
Range: Selects the correcting range. (Wide / Middle / Narrow)
Level: Sets the correcting level. (-7 (maximum black compression) to +7 (maximum black stretch))
Knee
Sets knee point and slope for video signal compression to prevent over-exposure by limiting signals in high intensity
areas of the subject to the dynamic range of your camera.
[Knee] is disabled if [Mode] is set to [Auto] when [Gamma] is set to [Still], [Cine1], [Cine2], [Cine3], [Cine4],
[ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2], [S-Log3], [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3]. To enable [Knee], set [Mode] to [Manual].
Mode: Selects auto/manual settings.
Auto: The knee point and slope are set automatically.
Manual: The knee point and slope are set manually.
471
Slope: Sets the knee slope. (-5 (gentle) to +5 (steep))
Color Mode
Sets type and level of colors.
In [Color Mode], only [BT.2020] and [709] are available when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3].
Movie: Suitable colors when [Gamma] is set to [Movie].
Still: Suitable colors when [Gamma] is set to [Still].
Cinema: Suitable colors when [Gamma] is set to [Cine1] or [Cine2].
Pro: Similar color tones to the standard image quality of Sony professional cameras (when combined with ITU709
gamma)
ITU709 Matrix: Colors corresponding to ITU709 standard (when combined with ITU709 gamma)
Black & White: Sets the saturation to zero for shooting in black and white.
S-Gamut: Setting based on the assumption that the pictures will be processed after shooting. Used when [Gamma] is set
to [S-Log2].
S-Gamut3.Cine: Setting based on the assumption that the pictures will be processed after shooting. Used when
[Gamma] is set to [S-Log3]. This setting allows you to shoot in a color space that can easily be converted for digital
cinema.
S-Gamut3: Setting based on the assumption that the pictures will be processed after shooting. Used when [Gamma] is
set to [S-Log3]. This setting allows you to shoot in a wide color space.
BT.2020: Standard color tone when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3].
709: Color tone when [Gamma] is set to [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3] and movies are recorded with HDTV color
(BT.709).
Saturation
Sets the color saturation. (-32 to +32)
Color Phase
Sets the color phase. (-7 to +7)
Color Depth
Sets the color depth for each color phase. This function is more effective for chromatic colors and less effective for
achromatic colors. The color looks deeper as you increase the setting value towards the positive side, and lighter as you
decrease the value towards the negative side. This function is effective even if you set [Color Mode] to [Black & White].
[R] -7 (light red) to +7 (deep red)
[G] -7 (light green) to +7 (deep green)
[B] -7 (light blue) to +7 (deep blue)
[C] -7 (light cyan) to +7 (deep cyan)
[M] -7 (light magenta) to +7 (deep magenta)
[Y] -7 (light yellow) to +7 (deep yellow)
Detail
Sets items for [Detail].
Level: Sets the [Detail] level. (-7 to +7)
Adjust: The following parameters can be selected manually.
Mode: Selects auto/manual setting. (Auto (automatic optimization) / Manual (The details are set manually.))
V/H Balance: Sets the vertical (V) and horizontal (H) balance of DETAIL. (-2 (off to the vertical (V) side) to +2 (off to
the horizontal (H) side))
B/W Balance: Selects the balance of the lower DETAIL (B) and the upper DETAIL (W). (Type1 (off to the lower
DETAIL (B) side) to Type5 (off to the upper DETAIL (W) side))
Limit: Sets the limit level of [Detail]. (0 (Low limit level: likely to be limited) to 7 (High limit level: unlikely to be limited))
Crispning: Sets the crispening level. (0 (shallow crispening level) to 7 (deep crispening level))
Hi-Light Detail: Sets the [Detail] level in the high intensity areas. (0 to 4)
472
You can copy the settings of the picture profile to another picture profile number.
MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Picture Profile] → [Copy].
Note
Since the parameters are shared for movie and still images, adjust the value when you change the shooting mode.
If you develop RAW images with shooting settings, the following settings are not reflected:
Black Level
Black Gamma
Knee
Color Depth
There may be more noise in dark parts depending on the gamma settings. It may improve by setting the lens compensation to
[Off].
When using S-Log2 or S-Log3 gamma, the noise becomes more noticeable compared to when using other gammas. If the noise
still is significant even after processing pictures, it may be improved by shooting with a brighter setting. However, the dynamic
range becomes narrower accordingly when you shoot with a brighter setting. We recommend checking the picture in advance by
test shooting when using S-Log2 or S-Log3.
Setting [ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2] or [S-Log3] may cause an error in the white balance custom setup. In this case, perform
custom setup with a gamma other than [ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2], or [S-Log3] first, and then reselect [ITU709(800%)], [S-Log2],
or [S-Log3] gamma.
If you set [Slope] to +5 in [Manual Set] under [Knee], [Knee] is set to [Off].
S-Gamut, S-Gamut3.Cine, and S-Gamut3 are color spaces exclusive to Sony. However, this camera's S-Gamut setting does not
support the whole S-Gamut color space; it is a setting to achieve a color reproduction equivalent to S-Gamut.
Related Topic
Gamma Disp. Assist
473
Help Guide
Focus Magnifier
You can check the focus by enlarging the image before shooting.
Unlike with [ MF Assist], you can magnify the image without operating the focus ring.
2 Press the center of the multi-selector to enlarge the image and select the area you want to enlarge by
pressing the multi-selector up/down/left/right.
Each time you press the center, the magnification scale will change.
You can set the initial magnification by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [ Initial Focus
Mag.].
Press the (Delete) button to bring the magnified position into the center of an image.
When the focus mode is [Manual Focus], you can adjust the focus while an image is magnified. If [ AF in
Focus Mag.] is set to [Off], the [Focus Magnifier] function is canceled when the shutter button is pressed
halfway down.
When the shutter button is pressed halfway down while an image is magnified during the auto-focusing,
different functions are performed depending on the [ AF in Focus Mag.] setting.
When [ AF in Focus Mag.] is set to [On]: Auto-focusing is performed again.
When [ AF in Focus Mag.] is set to [Off]: The [Focus Magnifier] function is canceled.
You can set how long the image is to be shown magnified by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) →
[Focus Magnif. Time].
Hint
While using the focus magnifier function, you can move the magnified area by dragging it on the touch panel.
To exit the focus magnifier function, double-tap the monitor again. When [ AF in Focus Mag.] is set to [Off], the focus
magnifier function is ended by pressing the shutter button halfway down.
Related Topic
MF Assist (still image)
Focus Magnif. Time
474
Initial Focus Mag. (still image)
AF in Focus Mag. (still image)
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Touch Operation
475
Help Guide
Set the duration for which an image is to be magnified using the [ MF Assist] or [Focus Magnifier] function.
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
MF Assist (still image)
476
Help Guide
Sets the initial magnification scale when using [Focus Magnifier]. Select a setting that will help you frame your shot.
x1.0:
Displays the image with the same magnification as the shooting screen.
x5.9:
Displays a 5.9-times enlarged image.
x1.0:
Displays the image with the same magnification as the shooting screen.
x3.8:
Displays a 3.8-times enlarged image.
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
477
Help Guide
You can focus on the subject more accurately using auto-focus by magnifying the area where you want to focus. While
the magnified image is displayed, you can focus on a smaller area than the flexible spot.
3 Magnify the image by pressing the center of the multi-selector, and then adjust the position by pressing the
multi-selector up/down/left/right.
The magnification scale changes each time you press the center.
Hint
Use of a tripod is recommended to accurately identify the location you want to magnify.
You can check the auto-focusing result by magnifying the displayed image. If you want to readjust the focus position, adjust the
focus area on the magnified screen and then press the shutter button halfway down.
Note
If you enlarge an area at the edge of the screen, the camera may not be able to focus.
The exposure and white balance cannot be adjusted while the displayed image is being magnified.
While the displayed image is being magnified, the following functions are unavailable:
[Eye AF]
[Center Lock-on AF]
[ Eye-Start AF]
[ Pre-AF]
[Face/Eye Prty in AF]
478
Related Topic
Focus Magnifier
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
479
Help Guide
Enlarges the image on the screen automatically to make manual focusing easier. This works in Manual Focus or Direct
Manual Focus shooting.
Hint
You can set how long the image is to be shown magnified by selecting MENU → (Camera Settings1) → [Focus Magnif.
Time].
Note
You cannot use [ MF Assist] when shooting movies. Use the [Focus Magnifier] function instead.
[ MF Assist] is not available when a Mount Adaptor is attached. Use the [Focus Magnifier] function instead.
Related Topic
Manual Focus
Direct manual focus (DMF)
Focus Magnif. Time
480
Help Guide
Peaking Setting
Sets the peaking function, which enhances the outline of in-focus areas during shooting with Manual Focus or Direct
Manual Focus.
Note
Since the product recognizes sharp areas as in focus, the effect of peaking differs, depending on the subject and lens.
The outline of in-focus ranges is not enhanced on devices connected via HDMI.
Related Topic
Manual Focus
Direct manual focus (DMF)
481
Help Guide
Detects flickering/blinking from artificial light sources such as fluorescent lighting and times the shooting of images to
moments when flickering will have less of an impact.
This function reduces differences in the exposure and color tone caused by flickering between the upper area and the
lower area of an image shot with fast shutter speed and during continuous shooting.
2 Press the shutter button halfway down, and then shoot the image.
The product detects flickering when the shutter button is pressed halfway down.
Hint
The color tone of the shot result may vary when you shoot the same scene using a different shutter speed. If that happens, we
recommend that you shoot in [Shutter Priority] or [Manual Exposure] mode with a fixed shutter speed.
You can perform anti-flicker shooting by pressing the shutter button halfway down even when in manual focus mode.
Note
The shutter release lag may increase slightly. In continuous shooting mode, the shooting speed may slow down or the interval
between each shot may become unequal.
The camera detects flickering when the frequency of the light source is 100 Hz or 120 Hz only.
The camera cannot detect flickering depending on the light source and shooting conditions, such as a dark background.
Even if the camera detects flickering, the influences caused by flickering may not be reduced enough depending on the light
source or the shooting situation. We recommend that you take test shots beforehand.
The color tone of the shot results may differ depending on the setting of [ Anti-flicker Shoot.].
482
Help Guide
If you register faces in advance, the product can focus on the registered face as a priority.
2 Align the guide frame with the face to be registered, and press the shutter button.
Note
Up to eight faces can be registered.
Shoot the face from the front in a brightly lit place. The face may not be registered correctly if it is obscured by a hat, a mask,
sunglasses, etc.
Related Topic
Face/Eye AF Set.
483
Help Guide
When multiple faces are registered to be given priority, the face registered first will be given priority. You can change the
priority order.
Related Topic
Face/Eye AF Set.
484
Help Guide
If you select [Delete All], you can delete all registered faces.
Note
Even if you execute [Delete], the data for registered face will remain in the product. To delete the data for registered faces from
the product, select [Delete All].
485
Help Guide
Sets whether to focus with higher priority on faces registered using [Face Registration].
Hint
To use the [Regist. Faces Priority] function, set as follows.
[Face/Eye Prty in AF] under [Face/Eye AF Set.]: [On]
[Subject Detection] under [Face/Eye AF Set.]: [Human] (when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later)
Related Topic
Face/Eye AF Set.
Face Registration (New Registration)
Face Registration (Order Exchanging)
Version
486
Help Guide
487
Help Guide
You can select the exposure mode for slow-motion/quick-motion shooting. You can change the setting and playback
speed for slow-motion/quick-motion shooting with [ S&Q Settings].
Related Topic
S&Q Settings
488
Help Guide
File Characteristics
Format
XAVC Records movies in crisper quality than AVCHD You can save movies on a computer using the
S HD with larger amounts of data. PlayMemories Home software.
The AVCHD format has a high degree of You can save movies on a computer or create a disc that
AVCHD compatibility with storage devices other than supports this format using the PlayMemories Home
computers. software.
Note
When [ File Format] is set to [AVCHD], the file size of movies is limited to approx. 2 GB. If the movie file size reaches approx.
2 GB during recording, a new movie file will be created automatically.
If you set [ File Format] to [XAVC S 4K] and shoot movies while the camera is connected to an HDMI device, images will not
be displayed on the monitor.
489
Help Guide
30p 100M/25p 100M Approx. 100 Mbps Records movies in 3840×2160 (30p/25p).
Record
Bit-rate Description
Setting
Approx. 50
24p 50M* Records movies in 1920×1080 (24p).
Mbps
490
Record
Bit-rate Description
Setting
60i 17M(FH)/50i 17M(FH) Approx. 17 Mbps on average Records movies in 1920×1080 (60i/50i).
Note
Creating an AVCHD recording disc from movies that were recorded with [60i 24M(FX)]/[50i 24M(FX)] as the [ Record Setting]
takes a long time because the image quality of movies is converted. If you want to store movies without converting them, use a
Blu-ray Disc.
In full-frame shooting, the angle of view will be narrower under the following conditions:
When [ File Format] is set to [XAVC S 4K] and [ Record Setting] is set to [30p]
Related Topic
APS-C/Super 35mm
Angle of view
491
Help Guide
S&Q Settings
You can record a moment that cannot be captured by the naked eye (slow-motion recording), or record a long-term
phenomenon into a compressed movie (quick-motion recording). For example, you can record an intense sports scene,
the moment when a bird starts to fly, a blooming flower, and a changing view of clouds or a starry sky. Sound will not be
recorded.
2 Select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Exposure Mode] → and select the desired setting of
slow-motion/quick-motion ( Program Auto, Aperture Priority, Shutter Priority, or
Manual Exposure).
3 Select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ S&Q Settings] and select the desired settings for [
Record Setting] and [ Frame Rate].
Playback speed
The playback speed will vary as below depending on the assigned [ Record Setting] and [ Frame Rate].
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to NTSC
Record Setting
Frame Rate
24p 30p 60p
492
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to PAL
Record Setting
Frame Rate
25p 50p
When [ Frame Rate] is set to [120fps]/[100fps], you cannot set [ Record Setting] to [60p]/[50p].
Note
In slow-motion recording, the shutter speed becomes faster and you may not be able to obtain the proper exposure. If this
happens, decrease the aperture value or adjust the ISO sensitivity to a higher value.
The bit-rate of a recorded movie varies depending on the settings for [ Frame Rate] and [ Record Setting].
Related Topic
S&Q Motion: Exposure Mode
Recordable movie times
493
Help Guide
Proxy Recording
Sets whether to simultaneously record low-bit-rate proxy movies when recording XAVC S movies. Since proxy movies
are small in file size, they are suitable for transferring to smartphones or uploading to websites.
Hint
Proxy movies are recorded in the XAVC S HD format (1280×720) at 9 Mbps. The frame rate of the proxy movie is the same as
that of the original movie.
Proxy movies are not displayed on the playback screen (single-image playback screen or image index screen). is displayed
over movies for which a proxy movie was simultaneously recorded.
Note
Proxy movies cannot be played back on this camera.
Deleting/protecting movies that have proxy movies removes/protects both the original and proxy movies. You cannot
delete/protect only original movies or proxy movies.
Related Topic
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Sending Target (proxy movies)
Movie recording formats
Playing back images on the image index screen (Image Index)
Memory cards that can be used
494
Help Guide
You can switch focusing speed when using autofocus in movie mode.
495
Help Guide
496
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to adjust the shutter speed automatically when recording movies if the subject is dark.
Note
[ Auto Slow Shut.] does not function in the following situations:
During slow-motion/quick-motion shooting
(Shutter Priority)
(Manual Exposure)
When [ISO] is set to other than [ISO AUTO]
497
Help Guide
Audio Recording
Sets whether to record sounds when shooting movies. Select [Off] to avoid recording the sounds of the lens and the
camera operating.
498
Help Guide
You can adjust the audio recording level while checking the level meter.
2 Select the desired level using the right/left sides of the control wheel.
Hint
When you record audio movies with loud volumes, set [Audio Rec Level] to a lower sound level. Doing so enables you to record
more realistic audio. When you record audio movies with lower volumes, set [Audio Rec Level] to a greater sound level to make
the sound easier to hear.
Note
Regardless of the [Audio Rec Level] settings, the limiter always operates.
[Audio Rec Level] is available only when the shooting mode is set to movie mode.
The [Audio Rec Level] settings are applied for both the internal microphone and the (microphone) terminal input.
499
Help Guide
Note
The audio level is not displayed in the following situations:
When [Audio Recording] is set to [Off].
When DISP (Display Setting) is set to [No Disp. Info.].
During slow-motion/quick-motion shooting
The audio level is also displayed while shooting stand-by in movie recording mode.
500
Help Guide
You can set echo cancellation during audio monitoring and prevent undesirable deviations between video and audio
during HDMI output.
501
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to reduce wind noise by cutting the low-range sound of the input audio from the built-in microphone.
Note
Setting this item to [On] where wind is not blowing sufficiently hard may cause normal sound to be recorded with too low volume.
When an external microphone (sold separately) is used, [Wind Noise Reduct.] does not function.
502
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to display markers set using [ Marker Settings] on the monitor or the viewfinder while shooting
movies.
Note
The markers are displayed when the mode dial is set to (Movie) or , or when shooting movies.
The markers are displayed on the monitor or viewfinder. (You cannot output the markers.)
Related Topic
Marker Settings (movie)
503
Help Guide
Hint
You can display several markers at the same time.
Place the subject on the cross point of the [Guideframe] to make a balanced composition.
504
Help Guide
Sets the illumination setting for the HVL-LBPC LED light (sold separately).
505
Help Guide
Movie w/ shutter
You can start or stop recording movies by pressing the shutter button, which is bigger and easier to press than the
MOVIE (Movie) button.
Hint
When [Movie w/ shutter] is set to [On], you can still start or stop recording movies using the MOVIE button.
When [Movie w/ shutter] is set to [On], you can use the shutter button to start or stop recording movies on an external
recording/playback device using [ REC Control].
Note
When [Movie w/ shutter] is set to [On], you cannot focus by pressing the shutter button halfway down during movie recording.
Related Topic
Shooting movies
506
Help Guide
Note
Use the [ Silent Shooting] function on your own responsibility, while taking sufficient consideration to the privacy and portrait
rights of the subject.
Even if [ Silent Shooting] is set to [On], the operating sound of the aperture and focus will sound.
When shooting still images using the [ Silent Shooting] function with low ISO sensitivity, if you point the camera at a very
bright light source, high intensity areas on the monitor may be recorded in darker tones.
When the power is turned off, the shutter sound may beep in rare occasions. This is not a malfunction.
Image distortion caused by the movement of the subject or the camera may occur. The distortion may become more noticeable
when [ RAW File Type] is set to [Uncompressed]. To decrease the distortion, set [ File Format] to [JPEG]. If you want to
shoot images in the RAW format with less distortion, set [Drive Mode] to [Cont. Shooting] and [ RAW File Type] to
[Compressed].
If you shoot images under instantaneous lightning or flickering lights, such as the flash light from other cameras or fluorescent
lighting, a striping effect may occur on the image.
If you want to turn off the beep that sounds when the subject is in focus or the self-timer operates, set [Audio signals] to [Off].
Even if [ Silent Shooting] is set to [On], the shutter sound may beep under the following circumstances:
When you capture a basic white color while the camera is set to the [Custom Setup] mode under [White Balance]
When you register faces using [Face Registration]
You cannot select [ Silent Shooting] when the mode dial is set to other than P/A/S/M.
When [ Silent Shooting] is set to [On], the following functions are not available:
Flash shooting
Auto HDR
Picture Effect
Picture Profile
Long Exposure NR
e-Front Curtain Shut.
BULB shooting
After you turn the camera on, the time in which you can start recording is extended by approximately 0.5 seconds.
507
Help Guide
The electronic front curtain shutter function shortens the time lag between when the shutter button is pressed and the
shutter is released.
Note
When you shoot at high shutter speeds with a large-aperture lens attached, out-of-focus circle produced by the bokeh effect may
get cut off because of the shutter mechanism. If this happens, set [e-Front Curtain Shut.] to [Off].
When a lens made by another manufacturer (including a Minolta/Konica-Minolta lens) is used, set this function to [Off]. If you set
this function to [On], the correct exposure will not be set or the image brightness will be uneven.
When you shoot at high shutter speeds, the image brightness may become uneven depending on the shooting environment. In
such cases, set [e-Front Curtain Shut.] to [Off].
508
Help Guide
Sets whether or not the shutter can be released when no lens is attached.
Note
Correct metering cannot be achieved when you use lenses that do not provide a lens contact, such as the lens of an
astronomical telescope. In such cases, adjust the exposure manually by checking it on the recorded image.
509
Help Guide
Sets whether the shutter can be released when no memory card has been inserted.
Note
When no memory card has been inserted, the images shot will not be saved.
The default setting is [Enable]. It is recommended that you select [Disable] prior to actual shooting.
510
Help Guide
SteadyShot
511
Help Guide
SteadyShot Settings
You can shoot with an appropriate SteadyShot setting for the attached lens.
Note
The SteadyShot function may not work optimally when the power has just been turned on, right after you point the camera
towards a subject, or when the shutter button has been pressed all the way down without stopping halfway.
When using a tripod, etc., make sure to turn off the SteadyShot function because this can cause any malfunction when shooting.
[SteadyShot Settings] will be unavailable when MENU→ (Camera Settings2)→[SteadyShot] is set to [Off].
When the camera cannot obtain focal length information from the lens, the SteadyShot function does not work correctly. Set
[SteadyShot Adjust.] to [Manual] and set [SteadyS. Focal Len.] to match the lens you are using. The current set value of the
SteadyShot focal length will display to the side of .
When using an SEL16F28 lens (sold separately) with a teleconverter, etc., set [SteadyShot Adjust.] to [Manual] and set the focal
length.
When you set [SteadyShot] to [On]/[Off], the SteadyShot settings of the camera and lens switch at the same time.
If a lens equipped with a SteadyShot switch is attached, the settings can only be changed using that switch on the lens. You
cannot switch the settings using the camera.
Related Topic
SteadyShot
512
Help Guide
When you use a zoom function other than the optical zoom, you can exceed the zoom range of the optical zoom.
2 When a power zoom lens is mounted, move the zoom lever or the zoom ring of the zoom lens to enlarge
subjects.
When you exceed the zoom range of the optical zoom, the camera automatically switches to another zoom than
the optical zoom.
3 When a lens other than a power zoom lens is mounted, select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Zoom]
→ desired value.
Related Topic
Zoom Setting
The zoom features available with this product
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
513
Help Guide
Zoom Setting
Note
Set [Optical zoom only] if you want to magnify images within the range in which image quality does not deteriorate.
Related Topic
The zoom features available with this product
About zoom scale
514
Help Guide
Assigns zoom in (T) or zoom out (W) functions to the zoom ring rotation direction. Available only with power zoom lenses
that support this function.
515
Help Guide
Allows you to set the screen display modes that can be selected using DISP (Display Setting) in shooting mode.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [DISP Button] → [Monitor] or [Finder] → desired setting → [Enter].
For viewfinder*:
Displays only shooting information on the monitor, not the subject. This setting is a display setting for shooting with the
viewfinder.
Monitor Off*:
Always turns the monitor off when shooting images. You can use the monitor when playing back images or operating
MENU. This setting is a display setting for shooting with the viewfinder.
* These screen modes are available only in the setting for [Monitor].
Note
If you tilt the product forward or backward by a large degree, the level error will be great.
The product may have a margin of error of almost ±1° even when the inclination is corrected by the level.
516
Related Topic
Switching the screen display (while shooting/during playback)
517
Help Guide
FINDER/MONITOR
Sets the method for switching the display between Electronic Viewfinder and the screen.
Hint
You can assign the [FINDER/MONITOR] function to your preferred key.
MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [ Custom Key], [ Custom Key] or [ Custom Key] → set [Finder/Monitor Sel.] to
the preferred key.
If you want to retain the Electronic Viewfinder display or the monitor display, set [FINDER/MONITOR] to [Viewfinder(Manual)] or
[Monitor(Manual)] beforehand.
You can keep the monitor off when you take your eyes off the Electronic Viewfinder during recording by setting the monitor
display to [Monitor Off] using the DISP button. Select MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [DISP Button] → [Monitor] and add
a check mark to [Monitor Off] beforehand.
Note
When the monitor is pulled out, the eye sensor of the camera will not detect your eye approaching even if [FINDER/MONITOR] is
set to [Auto]. The image will continue to be displayed on the monitor.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
DISP Button (Monitor/Finder)
518
Help Guide
Zebra Setting
Sets a zebra pattern, which appears over part of an image if the brightness level of that part meets the IRE level that you
have set. Use this zebra pattern as a guide to adjust the brightness.
Hint
You can register values to check the correct exposure or overexposure as well as the brightness level for [Zebra Level]. The
settings for correct exposure confirmation and overexposure confirmation are registered to [Custom1] and [Custom2] respectively
in the default settings.
To check the correct exposure, set a standard value and the range for the brightness level. The zebra pattern will appear on
areas that fall within the range you set.
To check the overexposure, set a minimum value for the brightness level. The zebra pattern will appear over areas with a
brightness level equal to or higher than the value you set.
Note
The zebra pattern is not displayed on devices connected via HDMI.
519
Help Guide
Grid Line
Sets whether the grid line is displayed or not. The grid line will help you to adjust the composition of images.
520
Help Guide
You can set whether to display a guide when you change the exposure.
521
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to show images altered with effects of the exposure compensation, white balance, [Creative Style],
or [Picture Effect] on the screen.
Hint
When you use a third-party flash, such as a studio flash, Live View Display may be dark for some shutter speed settings. When
[Live View Display] is set to [Setting Effect OFF], Live View Display will be displayed brightly, so that you can easily check the
composition.
Note
[Live View Display] cannot be set to [Setting Effect OFF] in the following shooting modes:
[Intelligent Auto]
[Movie]
[S&Q Motion]
[Scene Selection]
When [Live View Display] is set to [Setting Effect OFF], the brightness of the shot image will not be the same as that of the
displayed Live View.
522
Help Guide
Sets whether to display an indicator of the remaining time for which continuous shooting can be performed at the same
shooting speed.
Hint
When the internal camera memory for buffering is full, “SLOW” will be displayed and the continuous shooting speed will
decrease.
Related Topic
Cont. Shooting
523
Help Guide
Auto Review
You can check the recorded image on the screen right after the shooting. You can also set the display time for Auto
Review.
Note
When you use a function that performs image processing, the image before processing may be displayed temporarily, followed by
the image after processing.
The DISP (Display Setting) settings are applied for the Auto Review display.
Related Topic
Enlarging an image being played back (Enlarge Image)
524
Help Guide
2 Select the key to which you want to assign the function on the selection screen, and press the center of the
control wheel.
The keys that can be assigned functions are different for [ Custom Key], [ Custom Key] and [
Custom Key].
1. AF-ON Button
2. Custom Button 3
3. Custom Button 2
4. Custom Button 1
5. AEL Button
6. Center Button
7. Control Wheel/Down Button/Left Button/Right Button
8. Custom Button 4
9. Multi-Slc Center Btn
10. Fn/ Button
You can also assign a shooting function to the focus hold button on the lens. However, some lenses do not have
a focus hold button.
Related Topic
Using the control wheel
Using the multi-selector
Focus Standard
526
Help Guide
You can assign the functions to be called up when you press the Fn (Function) button.
1 MENU → (Camera Settings2) → [Function Menu Set.] → set a function to the desired location.
The functions that can be assigned are displayed on the setup item selection screen.
527
Help Guide
Dial Setup
Note
The [Dial Setup] function is enabled when the shooting mode is set to “M.”
528
Help Guide
Av/Tv Rotate
Sets the direction of rotation for the front dial, rear dial, or control wheel when changing the aperture value or shutter
speed.
529
Help Guide
Dial Ev Comp
You can adjust the exposure using the front dial or rear dial when the exposure compensation dial is set to “0.” You can
adjust the exposure in a range of -5.0 EV to +5.0 EV.
Note
When the exposure compensation function is assigned to the front or rear dial, any function that had been assigned to that dial
previously is re-assigned to another dial.
The settings of the exposure compensation dial will be prioritized over [Exposure Comp.] in MENU or the exposure settings using
the front or rear dial.
Related Topic
Exposure Comp.
530
Help Guide
MOVIE Button
531
Help Guide
You can set whether the multi-selector, dials, and wheel can be locked by pressing and holding down the Fn (Function)
button.
To lock the operating parts, hold down the Fn (function) button until the message “Locked.” appears on the
monitor.
Hint
You can release the lock by holding the Fn (Function) button down again.
Note
If you set [ AF Area Regist.] to [On], [Lock Operation Parts] will be fixed to [Off].
Related Topic
Registering the current focus area (AF Area Regist.) (still image)
532
Help Guide
Audio signals
Note
If [Focus Mode] is set to [Continuous AF], the camera will not beep when it focuses on a subject.
533
Help Guide
Function Ring(Lens)
You can choose which of the following functions to assign to the function ring on the lens: power-assisted focusing
(power focus), or switching the angle of view between full frame and APS-C/Super 35 mm (available only with
compatible lenses).
This function can be used when the camera's system software (firmware) is Ver. 2.00 or later.
For details, refer to the operating instructions supplied with the lens.
Related Topic
APS-C/Super 35mm
Version
534
Help Guide
You can transfer still images, XAVC S movies, slow-motion movies, or quick-motion movies to a smartphone and view
them. The application PlayMemories Mobile must be installed on your smartphone.
If you press the (Send to Smartphone) button in playback mode, the setting screen for [Send to
Smartphone] will appear.
2 If the product is ready for the transfer, the information screen appears on the product. Connect the
smartphone and the product using that information.
The setting method for connecting the smartphone and the product varies depending on the smartphone.
The options displayed may differ depending on the View Mode selected on the camera.
(2) If you select [Multiple Images], select the desired images using the center of the control wheel, then press MENU →
[Enter].
Select on Smartphone:
Displays all images recorded on the product’s memory card on the smartphone.
Note
You can only transfer images that are saved on the camera's memory card.
You can only transfer images that are saved on the memory card in the memory card slot being played back. To change which
memory card slot is being played back, select MENU → (Playback) → [Select PB Media] → the desired slot.
You can select an image size to be sent to the smartphone from [Original], [2M] or [VGA].
To change the image size, refer to the following steps.
For Android smartphone
Start PlayMemories Mobile, and change the image size by [Settings] → [Copy Image Size].
For iPhone/iPad
Select PlayMemories Mobile in the setting menu, and change the image size by [Copy Image Size].
RAW images are converted to JPEG format when they are sent.
535
You cannot transfer XAVC S 4K movies or the original data of XAVC S HD movies recorded in [120p]/[100p] to a smartphone.
You can only transfer proxy movies.
Depending on the smartphone, the transferred movie may not be played back correctly. For example, the movie may not play
smoothly, or there may be no sound.
Depending on the format of the still image, movie, slow-motion movie, or quick-motion movie, it may not be possible to play it
back on a smartphone.
This product shares the connection information for [Send to Smartphone] with a device that has permission to connect. If you
want to change the device that is permitted to connect to the product, reset the connection information by following these steps.
MENU → (Network) → [Wi-Fi Settings] → [SSID/PW Reset]. After resetting the connection information, you must register the
smartphone again.
When [Airplane Mode] is set to [On], you cannot connect this product and the smartphone. Set [Airplane Mode] to [Off].
While you transfer many images or long movies, we recommend that you supply power to the camera from a wall outlet (wall
socket) using the AC Adaptor (supplied).
Related Topic
PlayMemories Mobile
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (NFC One-touch remote)
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (QR code)
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (SSID)
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (QR code)
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (SSID)
Sending images to an Android smartphone (NFC One-touch Sharing)
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Sending Target (proxy movies)
Airplane Mode
536
Help Guide
When transferring XAVC S video to a smartphone with [Send to Smartphone], you can set whether to transfer the low-
bit-rate proxy movie or the high-bit-rate original movie.
Note
You cannot transfer XAVC S 4K movies or the original data of XAVC S HD movies recorded in [120p]/[100p] to a smartphone.
You can only transfer proxy movies.
While you transfer many images or long movies, we recommend that you supply power to the camera from a wall outlet (wall
socket) using the AC Adaptor (supplied).
Related Topic
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Proxy Recording
537
Help Guide
Send to Computer
You can transfer images stored in the product to a computer connected to a wireless access point or wireless broadband
router and easily make backup copies using this operation. Before starting this operation, install PlayMemories Home on
your computer and register the access point on the product.
Note
Depending on the application settings of your computer, the product will turn off after saving the images to your computer.
You can transfer images from the product to only one computer at a time.
If you want to transfer images to another computer, connect the product and the computer via a USB connection and follow the
instructions in PlayMemories Home.
Related Topic
Installing PlayMemories Home
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
538
Help Guide
You can set up image transferring using an FTP server or transfer images to the FTP server. Basic knowledge of FTP
servers is required.
For details, refer to the “FTP Help Guide.”
https://rd1.sony.net/help/di/ftp/h_zz/
Related Topic
Importing root certification to the camera (Imp Root Certificate)
539
Help Guide
View on TV
You can view images on a network-enabled TV by transferring them from the product without connecting the product and
TV with a cable. For some TVs, you may need to perform operations on the TV. For details, refer to the operating
instructions supplied with the TV.
2 When you want to play back images using slideshow, press the center of the control wheel.
To display the next/previous image manually, press the right/left sides of the control wheel.
To change the device to be connected, press the down side of the control wheel, then select [Device list].
Slideshow settings
You can change the slideshow settings by pressing the down side of the control wheel.
Playback Selection:
Selects the group of images to be shown.
Folder View(Still):
Selects from [All] and [All in Folder].
Date View:
Selects from [All] and [All with this date].
Interval:
Selects from [Short] and [Long].
Effects*:
Selects from [On] and [Off].
Playback Image Size:
Selects from [HD] and [4K].
* The settings are effective only for BRAVIA TV which is compatible with the functions.
Note
You can only transfer images that are saved on the memory card in the memory card slot being played back. To change the
memory card slot to be played back, select MENU → (Playback) → [Select PB Media] → the desired slot.
You can view images on a Wi-Fi Direct-enabled TV or network-enabled TV (including wired network-enabled TVs).
If you connect TV and this product and do not use Wi-Fi Direct, you need to register your access point first.
Movies cannot be shown on a TV via Wi-Fi. Use an HDMI cable (sold separately).
540
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
541
Help Guide
Ctrl w/ Smartphone
Note
If [Always Connected] is set to [On], the power consumption will be greater than when it is set to [Off].
Related Topic
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (NFC One-touch remote)
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (QR code)
Controlling the camera using an Android smartphone (SSID)
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (QR code)
Controlling the camera using an iPhone or iPad (SSID)
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
542
Help Guide
Airplane Mode
When you board an airplane, etc., you can temporarily disable all the wireless-related functions including Wi-Fi.
If you set [Airplane Mode] to [On], an airplane mark will be displayed on the screen.
543
Help Guide
If your access point has a Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) button, you can register the access point to this product easily.
2 Push the Wi-Fi Protected Setup (WPS) button on the access point to connect.
Note
[WPS Push] works only if the security setting of your access point is set to WPA or WPA2 and your access point supports the Wi-
Fi Protected Setup (WPS) button method. If the security setting is set to WEP or your access point does not support the Wi-Fi
Protected Setup (WPS) button method, perform [Access Point Set.].
For details about the available functions and settings of your access point, see the access point operating instructions or contact
the administrator of the access point.
A connection may not be possible or the communication distance may be shorter depending on the surrounding conditions, such
as the type of wall material and the presence of obstructions or radio waves between the product and access point. In this case,
change the location of the product or move the product closer to the access point.
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
544
Help Guide
You can register your access point manually. Before starting the procedure, check the SSID name of the access point,
security system, and password. The password may be preset in some devices. For details, see the access point
operating instructions, or consult the access point administrator.
When the desired access point is displayed on the screen: Select the desired access point.
When the desired access point is not displayed on the screen: Select [Manual Setting] and set the access
point.
If you select [Manual Setting], input the SSID name of the access point, then select the security system.
4 Select [OK].
WPS PIN:
Displays the PIN code you enter into the connected device.
Priority Connection:
Select [On] or [Off].
IP Address Setting:
545
Select [Auto] or [Manual].
IP Address:
If you are entering the IP address manually, enter the set address.
Subnet Mask/Default Gateway/Primary DNS Server/Second DNS Server:
If you have set [IP Address Setting] to [Manual], enter each address according to your network environment.
Note
To give the registered access point priority in the future, set [Priority Connection] to [On].
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
How to use the keyboard
546
Help Guide
547
Help Guide
This product shares the connection information for [Send to Smartphone] and [ Connection] with a device that has
permission to connect. If you want to change the device that is permitted to connect, reset the connection information.
Note
If you connect this product to a smartphone after resetting the connection information, you must make the settings for the
smartphone again.
Related Topic
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Ctrl w/ Smartphone
548
Help Guide
Bluetooth Settings
Controls the settings for connecting the camera to a smartphone or Bluetooth remote commander via a Bluetooth
connection.
If you want to pair the camera and smartphone in order to use the location information link function, refer to “Loc. Info.
Link Set..”
If you want to perform pairing in order to use a Bluetooth remote commander, refer to “Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl.”
Related Topic
Loc. Info. Link Set.
Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl
549
Help Guide
You can use the application PlayMemories Mobile to obtain location information from a smartphone that is connected
with your camera using Bluetooth communication. You can record the obtained location information when shooting
images.
Preparation in advance
To use the location information linking function of the camera, the application PlayMemories Mobile is required.
If “Location Information Linkage” is not displayed on the top page of PlayMemories Mobile, you need to perform the
following steps beforehand.
You can install PlayMemories Mobile from the application store of your smartphone. If you have already installed
the application, update it to the latest version.
2. Transfer a pre-recorded image to your smartphone using the [Send to Smartphone] function of the camera.
After you transfer an image recorded using the camera to your smartphone, “Location Information Linkage” will
appear on the top page of the application.
Operating procedure
: Operations performed on the smartphone
: Operations performed on the camera
Do not perform the Bluetooth pairing operation on the smartphone setting screen. In steps 2 to 7, the pairing
operation is performed using the camera and the application PlayMemories Mobile.
If you accidentally perform the pairing operation on the smartphone setting screen in step 1, cancel the pairing
and then perform the pairing operation by following Steps 2 through 7 using the camera and the application
PlayMemories Mobile.
2. : On the camera, select MENU → (Network) → [Bluetooth Settings] → [Bluetooth Function] → [On].
4. : Launch PlayMemories Mobile on your smartphone and tap “Location Information Linkage.”
If “Location Information Linkage” is not displayed, follow the steps in “Preparation in advance” above.
5. : Activate [Location Information Linkage] on the [Location Information Linkage] setting screen of PlayMemories
Mobile.
6. : Follow the instructions on the [Location Information Linkage] setting screen of PlayMemories Mobile, and then
select your camera from the list.
550
8. : On the camera, select MENU → (Network) → [ Loc. Info. Link Set.] → [Location Info. Link] → [On].
(obtaining location information icon) will be displayed on the monitor of the camera. Location information
obtained by your smartphone using GPS, etc., will be recorded when shooting images.
Hint
Location information can be linked when PlayMemories Mobile is running on your smartphone even if the smartphone monitor is
off. However, if the camera has been turned off for a while, location information may not be linked immediately when you turn the
camera back on. In this case, location information will be linked immediately if you open the PlayMemories Mobile screen on the
smartphone.
When PlayMemories Mobile is not operating, such as when the smartphone is restarted, launch PlayMemories Mobile to resume
location information linking.
If the location information linking function does not work properly, see the following notes and perform pairing again.
Confirm that the Bluetooth function of your smartphone is activated.
Confirm that the camera is not connected with other devices using the Bluetooth function.
Confirm that [Airplane Mode] for the camera is set to [Off].
Delete the pairing information for the camera registered in PlayMemories Mobile.
Execute [Reset Network Set.] of the camera.
Note
When you initialize the camera, the pairing information is also deleted. To perform pairing again, delete the pairing information for
the camera registered in PlayMemories Mobile before trying again.
The location information will not be recorded when it cannot be obtained, such as when the Bluetooth connection is
disconnected.
The camera can be paired with up to 15 Bluetooth devices, but can link the location information with that of only one smartphone.
If you want to link the location information with that of another smartphone, turn off the [Location Information Linkage] function of
the smartphone that is already linked.
If the Bluetooth connection is unstable, remove any obstacles, such as people or metal objects from between the camera and the
paired smartphone.
When pairing the camera and your smartphone, be sure to use the [Location Information Linkage] menu on PlayMemories
Mobile.
To use the location information linkage function, set [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] to [Off].
Supported smartphones
Android smartphones: Android 5.0 or later and compatible with Bluetooth 4.0 or later*
Related Topic
PlayMemories Home
PlayMemories Mobile
Snd to Smrtphn Func: Send to Smartphone
Bluetooth Settings
Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl
552
Help Guide
You can operate the camera using a Bluetooth remote commander RMT-P1BT (sold separately). Select MENU →
(Network) → [Bluetooth Settings] → [Bluetooth Function] → [On] in advance. Refer to the instruction manual for the
Bluetooth remote commander as well.
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
If there is no Bluetooth device currently paired with the camera, the screen for pairing as described in Step 2 will
appear.
2 On the camera, select MENU → (Network) → [Bluetooth Settings] → [Pairing] to display the screen for
pairing.
For details, refer to the instruction manual for the Bluetooth remote commander.
4 On the camera, select [OK] on the confirmation screen for the Bluetooth connection.
Pairing is complete, and you can now operate the camera from the Bluetooth remote commander. After pairing
the device once, you can connect the camera and the Bluetooth remote commander again in the future by
setting [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] to [On].
Hint
The Bluetooth connection is only active while you are operating the camera using the Bluetooth remote commander.
If the function does not work properly, check the following notes and then try pairing again.
Confirm that the camera is not connected with other devices using the Bluetooth function.
Confirm that [Airplane Mode] for the camera is set to [Off].
Execute [Reset Network Set.] of the camera.
Note
When you initialize the camera, the pairing information is also deleted. To use the Bluetooth remote commander, perform pairing
again.
If the Bluetooth connection is unstable, remove any obstacles, such as people or metal objects from between the camera and the
paired Bluetooth remote commander.
You cannot use the function for linking location information with a smartphone while [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On].
You cannot use an infrared remote commander while [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On].
553
While [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On], the camera will not switch to the power-saving mode. Change the setting to [Off] when
you are done using the Bluetooth remote commander.
Related Topic
Bluetooth Settings
Version
554
Help Guide
You can change the device name for the Wi-Fi Direct or Bluetooth connection.
Related Topic
Wi-Fi Settings: WPS Push
Wi-Fi Settings: Access Point Set.
How to use the keyboard
555
Help Guide
Imports a root certificate needed to verify a server from a memory card. Use this function for encrypted communications
during FTP transfer.
For details, refer to the “FTP Help Guide.”
http://rd1.sony.net/help/di/ftp/h_zz/
556
Help Guide
557
Help Guide
Protects recorded images against accidental erasure. The mark is displayed on protected images.
Hint
The [Protect] function is assigned to the C3 button in the default settings.
If you select a group in [Multiple Img.], all the images in the group will be protected. To select and protect particular images within
the group, execute [Multiple Img.] while displaying the images within the group.
Note
The menu items that can be selected vary according to the [View Mode] setting and the selected content.
558
Help Guide
Note
You cannot rotate the movies.
You may not be able to rotate images shot using other products.
When viewing rotated images on a computer, the images may be displayed in their original orientation depending on the
software.
559
Help Guide
You can delete multiple selected images. Once you have deleted an image, you cannot restore it. Confirm the image to
be deleted beforehand.
Hint
Perform [Format] to delete all images, including protected images.
To display the desired folder or date, select the desired folder or date during playback by performing the following procedure:
(Image Index) button → select the bar on the left using the control wheel → select the desired folder or date using the
top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
If you select a group in [Multiple Img.], all the images in the group will be deleted. To select and delete particular images within
the group, execute [Multiple Img.] while displaying the images within the group.
Note
The protected images cannot be deleted.
The menu items that can be selected vary according to the [View Mode] setting and the selected content.
Related Topic
Deleting a displayed image
Format
560
Help Guide
Rating
You can assign ratings to recorded images on a scale from to to make it easier to find images. Combining this
function with [Image Jump Setting] allows you to find a desired image quickly.
2 Press the left/right sides of the control wheel to display an image to which you want to assign a rating, and
then press the center.
3 Select the number of (Rating) by pressing the left/right sides of the control wheel, and then press the
center.
Hint
You can also assign ratings when playing back images by using the custom key. Assign [Rating] to the desired key using [
Custom Key] beforehand, and then press the custom key while playing back an image to which you want to assign a rating. The
number of (Rating) changes each time you press the custom key.
Note
You can assign ratings to still images only.
Related Topic
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
Rating Set(Cust Key)
Setting the method for jumping between images (Image Jump Setting)
561
Help Guide
Sets the available number of when rating images with the key to which you have assigned [Rating] using [
Custom Key].
You can select the checked number when setting [Rating] using the custom key.
Related Topic
Rating
Custom Key (still image/movie/playback)
562
Help Guide
You can specify in advance on the memory card which still images you want to print out later. The (print order)
icon will appear on the specified images. DPOF refers to “Digital Print Order Format.”
DPOF setting will be retained after the image is printed. We recommend that you cancel this setting after printing.
Cancel All:
Clears all DPOF marks.
Print Setting:
Sets whether to print the date on images registered with DPOF marks.
The position or size of the date (inside or outside of the image) may differ depending on the printer.
Note
You cannot add the DPOF mark to the following files:
RAW images
563
Help Guide
You can copy images from a memory card in a slot that is selected using [Select PB Media] to a memory card in another
slot.
All of the contents with a date or in a folder currently being played back will be copied to a memory card in another
slot.
Hint
You can select the type of images to be displayed by selecting MENU → (Playback) → [View Mode].
Note
If images in a group are copied, the copied images will not be displayed as a group on the destination memory card.
If protected images are copied, the protection will be canceled on the destination memory card.
It may take a long time when many images are to be copied. Use a sufficiently charged battery pack.
XAVC S movies can only be copied to a memory card that supports XAVC S movies. A message will be displayed on the monitor
of the camera when images cannot be copied.
Related Topic
Selecting which memory card to play back (Select PB Media)
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
564
Help Guide
Photo Capture
Captures a chosen scene in a movie to save as a still image. First shoot a movie, then pause the movie during playback
to capture decisive moments that tend to be missed when shooting still images, and save them as still images.
4 Find the desired scene using forward slow playback, reverse slow playback, displays the next frame, and
displays the previous frame, and then stop the movie.
Related Topic
Shooting movies
Playing back movies
565
Help Guide
Enlarges the image being played back. Use this function to check the focus of the image, etc.
1 Display the image you want to enlarge, and then press the button.
Turn the control wheel to adjust the zoom scale. By rotating the front/rear dial, you can switch to the previous or
next image while keeping the same zoom scale.
The view will zoom in on the part of the image where the camera focused during shooting. If the focus location
information cannot be obtained, the camera will zoom in on the center of the image.
2 Select the portion you want to enlarge by pressing the top/bottom/right/left sides of the control wheel.
3 Press the MENU button or the center of the control wheel to exit the playback zoom.
Hint
You can also enlarge an image being played back using MENU.
You can change the initial magnification and initial position of enlarged images by selecting MENU → (Playback) → [
Enlarge Init. Mag.] or [ Enlarge Initial Pos.].
You can also enlarge an image by double-tapping the monitor. In addition, you can drag and move the magnified position on the
monitor. Set [Touch Operation] to [On] beforehand.
Note
You cannot enlarge movies.
Related Topic
Touch Operation
Enlarge Init. Mag.
Enlarge Initial Pos.
566
Help Guide
Sets the initial magnification scale when playing back enlarged images.
Related Topic
Enlarging an image being played back (Enlarge Image)
Enlarge Initial Pos.
567
Help Guide
Related Topic
Enlarging an image being played back (Enlarge Image)
Enlarge Init. Mag.
568
Help Guide
2 Select [Enter].
Hint
During playback, you can display the next/previous image by pressing the right/left side of the control wheel.
You can activate a slideshow only when [View Mode] is set to [Date View] or [Folder View(Still)].
569
Help Guide
Note
No image is played back when no memory card is inserted in the selected slot. Select a slot into which a memory card has been
inserted.
When you select [Date View] in [View Mode], the camera only plays back images from a memory card selected using [Select PB
Media].
Related Topic
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
570
Help Guide
571
Help Guide
You can display multiple images at the same time in playback mode.
1 Press the (Image Index) button while the image is being played back.
2 Select the image by pressing the top/bottom/right/left sides of the control wheel or turning the control
wheel.
Related Topic
Switching between still images and movies (View Mode)
572
Help Guide
Display as Group
Sets whether or not to display continuously shot images or images shot using interval shooting as a group.
Hint
The following images are grouped.
Images shot with [Drive Mode] set to [Cont. Shooting] (One sequence of images shot continuously by holding down the shutter
button during continuous shooting becomes one group.)
Images shot with [ Intvl. Shoot. Func.] (Images shot during one session of interval shooting become one group.)
Note
Images can be grouped and displayed only when [View Mode] is set to [Date View]. When it is not set to [Date View], images
cannot be grouped and displayed, even if [Display as Group] is set to [On].
If you delete the group, all the images in the group will be deleted.
Related Topic
Cont. Shooting
Intvl. Shoot. Func.
573
Help Guide
Related Topic
Rotating an image (Rotate)
574
Help Guide
Setting the method for jumping between images (Image Jump Setting)
Sets which dial and method to use for jumping between images during playback. You can quickly find protected images
or images set with a particular rating.
Note
[Image Jump Setting] is available only when [View Mode] is set to [Date View]. If [View Mode] is not set to [Date View], the
camera will always play back every image without jumping when you use the dial selected with [Select Dial].
When you use the Image Jump function, movie files are always skipped.
Related Topic
Rating
Protecting images (Protect)
575
Help Guide
2 Select the image group that you want to play back, and then press the center of the control wheel.
Hint
On the playback screen, you can start continuous playback by pressing the down button while displaying an image in the group.
You can resume play or pause by pressing the down button during playback.
You can change the playback speed by turning the front dial, rear dial, or control wheel during playback. You can also change the
playback speed by selecting MENU → (Playback) → [PB Speed for Intvl].
You can continuously play back images shot with continuous shooting as well.
Related Topic
Intvl. Shoot. Func.
PB Speed for Intvl
Imaging Edge
Version
576
Help Guide
Sets the playback speed for still images during [Cont. PB for Intvl.].
This function can be used when the camera’s system software (firmware) is Ver. 3.00 or later.
Hint
You can also change the playback speed by turning the front dial, rear dial, or control wheel during [Cont. PB for Intvl.].
Related Topic
Cont. PB for Intvl.
Version
577
Help Guide
Monitor Brightness
Note
The [Sunny Weather] setting is too bright for shooting indoors. Set [Monitor Brightness] to [Manual] for indoor shooting.
578
Help Guide
Viewfinder Bright.
When using an electronic viewfinder, this product adjusts the brightness of the electronic viewfinder according to the
surrounding environment.
579
Help Guide
580
Help Guide
Movies with S-Log gamma are assumed to be processed after shooting in order to make use of the wide dynamic range.
Movies with the HLG gamma are assumed to be displayed on HDR-compatible monitors. They are therefore displayed in
low contrast during shooting and may be difficult to monitor, using [Gamma Disp. Assist], contrast equivalent to that of
normal gamma can be reproduced. In addition, [Gamma Disp. Assist] can also be applied when playing back movies on
the camera's monitor/viewfinder.
2 Select the desired setting using the top/bottom sides of the control wheel.
Note
Movies in the XAVC S 4K or XAVC S HD format with the [HLG], [HLG1], [HLG2], or [HLG3] gamma are displayed with an
[HLG(BT.2020)] effect or [HLG(709)] effect depending on the movie’s gamma value and color mode. In other situations, movies
are displayed according to the gamma setting and color mode setting in [Picture Profile].
[Gamma Disp. Assist] is not applied to movies when displayed on a TV or monitor connected to the camera.
Related Topic
Picture Profile
581
Help Guide
Volume Settings
582
Help Guide
Delete confirm.
You can set whether [Delete] or [Cancel] is selected as a default on the delete confirmation screen.
583
Help Guide
Display Quality
Note
When [High] is set, battery consumption will be higher than when [Standard] is set.
When the temperature of the camera rises, the setting may become locked to [Standard].
584
Help Guide
Sets time intervals to automatically switch to power save mode when you are not performing operations to prevent
wearing down the battery pack. To return to shooting mode, perform an operation such as pressing the shutter button
halfway down.
Note
Turn off the product when you do not use it for a long time.
The power save function is not activated when power is being supplied via USB, when playing back slideshows, when recording
movies, or when connected to a computer or TV.
585
Help Guide
Sets the temperature of the camera at which the camera turns off automatically during shooting. When it is set to [High],
you can continue shooting even when the temperature of the camera gets hotter than normal.
Continuous recording time for movies when [Auto Pwr OFF Temp.] is set to [High]
The duration of time available for continuous movie recording is as follows when the camera starts recording with the
default settings after the power has been turned off for a while. The following values indicate the continuous time from
when the camera starts recording until the camera stops recording.
Note
Even if [Auto Pwr OFF Temp.] is set to [High], depending on the conditions or the temperature of the camera, the recordable time
for movies may not change.
Related Topic
Recordable movie times
586
Help Guide
NTSC/PAL Selector
Plays back movies recorded with the product on a NTSC/PAL system TV.
Note
If you insert a memory card that has previously been formatted with a different video system, a message telling you that you must
reformat the card will appear.
If you want to record using another system, re-format the memory card or use another memory card.
When you perform [NTSC/PAL Selector], and the setting is changed from the default one, a message "Running on NTSC." or
"Running on PAL." will appear on the start-up screen.
When [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to PAL, the viewfinder or monitor of the camera or the screen of an HDMI-connected device
may black out for an instant in the following situations. This is not a malfunction.
When you start or stop recording movies while the shooting mode is set to a mode other than (Movie) or .
When you change the shooting mode from (Movie) or to another mode.
When you play back a movie for the first time after switching to the playback mode.
587
Help Guide
Cleaning Mode
If dust or debris gets inside the camera and adheres to the surface of the image sensor (the part that converts the light to
an electric signal), it may appear as dark spots on the image, depending on the shooting environment. If this happens,
follow the steps below to clean the image sensor.
5 Use the blower to clean the image sensor surface and the surrounding area.
Hint
For how to check the amount of dust on the image sensor, and for further details on cleaning methods, please refer to the
following URL.
http://support.d-imaging.sony.co.jp/www/support/ilc/sensor/index.php
Note
Clean the image sensor quickly.
A blower is not supplied with this product. Use a commercially available blower.
Make sure that the remaining battery level is (3 remaining battery icons) or more, before performing the cleaning. The use
of AC adaptor (supplied) is recommended.
Do not use a spray type blower as it may scatter water droplets inside the camera body.
Do not put the tip of a blower into the cavity beyond the lens mount area, so that the tip of the blower does not touch the image
sensor.
588
Hold the camera slightly face downward so that the dust falls out.
When cleaning the image sensor with a blower, do not blow too hard. If you blow the sensor too hard, the inside of the product
may be damaged.
If the dust remains even after you cleaned the product as described, consult the service facility.
Related Topic
Troubleshooting
589
Help Guide
Touch Operation
Related Topic
Touch Focus
Touch Pad Settings
Touch Panel/Pad
590
Help Guide
Touch Panel/Pad
Touch operations when shooting with the monitor are referred to as "touch panel operations," and touch operations when
shooting with the viewfinder are referred to as "touch pad operations." You can select whether to activate touch panel
operations or touch pad operations.
Related Topic
Touch Operation
591
Help Guide
You can adjust settings related to touch pad operations during viewfinder shooting.
Selecting [Relative Position] lets you operate the touch pad from wherever is easiest, without having to move your finger
over a wide area.
Hint
In touch pad operations when [Touch Pos. Mode] is set to [Absolute Position], the area set in [Operation Area] is treated as the
entire screen.
592
Related Topic
Touch Operation
593
Help Guide
Demo Mode
The [Demo Mode] function displays the movies recorded on the memory card automatically (demonstration), when the
camera has not been operated for a certain time. Normally select [Off].
Note
You can set this item only when the product is powered by the AC Adaptor (supplied).
When there is no protected AVCHD movies on the memory card, you cannot select [On].
[Demo Mode] always displays movies on the memory card in memory card slot 1.
594
Help Guide
TC/UB Settings
The time code (TC) and the user bit (UB) information can be recorded as data attached to movies.
3. Set the other digits following the same procedure as in step 2, then press in the center of the control wheel.
How to select the recording method for the time code (TC Format *1)
595
1. MENU → (Setup) → [TC/UB Settings] → [TC Format].
DF:
Records the time code in Drop Frame*2 format.
NDF:
Records the time code in Non-Drop Frame format.
*1 Only when [NTSC/PAL Selector] is set to NTSC.
*2 The time code is based on 30 frames per second. However, a gap between the actual time and the time code will occur during extended periods
of recording as the frame frequency of the NTSC image signal is approximately 29.97 frames per second. Drop frame corrects this gap to make
the time code and actual time equal. In drop frame, the first 2 frame numbers are removed every minute except for every tenth minute. The time
code without this correction is called non-drop frame.
The setting is fixed to [NDF] when recording in 4K/24p or 1080/24p.
How to select the count up format for the time code (TC Run)
Rec Run:
Sets the stepping mode for the time code to advance only while recording. The time code is recorded sequentially from
the last time code of the previous recording.
Free Run:
Sets the stepping mode for the time code to advance anytime, regardless of the camera operation.
The time code may not be recorded sequentially in the following situations even when the time code advances in
[Rec Run] mode.
When the recording format is changed.
When the recording medium is removed.
596
Help Guide
IR Remote Ctrl
You can operate this product and shoot images using the SHUTTER button, 2SEC button (2 second delay shutter), and
START/STOP button (or Movie button (RMT-DSLR2 only)) on the Wireless Remote Commander RMT-DSLR1 (sold
separately) and RMT-DSLR2 (sold separately). Refer also to the operating instructions for the Infrared Remote
Commander.
Note
The lens or lens hood may block the infrared remote sensor that receive the signals. Use the infrared remote commander in the
position from which the signal can reach the product.
When [IR Remote Ctrl] is set to [On], the product does not switch to power save mode. Set [Off] after using an infrared remote
commander.
An infrared remote commander cannot be used while [Bluetooth Rmt Ctrl] is set to [On].
597
Help Guide
When you connect the product to a High Definition (HD) TV with HDMI terminals using an HDMI cable (sold separately),
you can select HDMI Resolution to output images to the TV.
Note
If the images are not displayed properly using the [Auto] setting, select either [1080i], [1080p] or [2160p/1080p], based on which
TV is to be connected.
598
Help Guide
HDMI Settings: 24p/60p Output (movie) (Only for 1080 60i compatible models)
You can set 1080/24p or 1080/60p as the HDMI output format when [ Record Setting] is set to [24p 50M], [24p 60M]
or [24p 100M].
Note
Steps 1 and 2 can be set in either order.
Related Topic
Record Setting (movie)
599
Help Guide
Selects whether to display the shooting information when this product and the TV are connected using an HDMI cable
(sold separately).
Off:
Does not display the shooting information on the TV.
Only the recorded image is displayed on the TV, while the recorded image and the shooting information are displayed on
the camera’s monitor.
Note
When this product is connected to a 4K-compatible TV, [Off] is selected automatically.
If you set [ File Format] to [XAVC S 4K] and shoot movies while the camera is connected to an HDMI device, images will not
be displayed on the monitor.
600
Help Guide
Sets whether or not to layer the TC (time code) information on the output signal via the HDMI terminal when outputting
the signal to other professional-use devices.
This function layers the time code information on the HDMI output signal. The product sends the time code information
as digital data, not as an image displayed on the screen. The connected device can then refer to the digital data to
recognize the time data.
Note
When [ TC Output] is set to [On], the image may not be output properly to the TV or recording device. In such cases, set [
TC Output] to [Off].
601
Help Guide
If you connect the camera to an external recorder/player, you can remotely command the recorder/player to start/stop
recording using the camera.
Note
Available for external recorders/players compatible with [ REC Control].
When you use the [ REC Control] function, set the shooting mode to (Movie).
When [ TC Output] is set to [Off], you cannot use the [ REC Control] function.
Even when is displayed, the external recorder/player may not work properly depending on the settings or status of the
recorder/player. Check if the external recorder/player works properly before use.
602
Help Guide
When connecting this product to a “BRAVIA” Sync-compatible TV using an HDMI cable (sold separately), you can
operate this product by aiming the TV remote control at the TV.
Note
If you connect this product to a TV using an HDMI cable, available menu items are limited.
[CTRL FOR HDMI] is available only with a “BRAVIA” Sync-compatible TV. Also, the SYNC MENU operation differs depending on
the TV you are using. For details, refer to the operating instructions supplied with the TV.
If the product performs unwanted operations in response to the TV remote control when the product is connected to another
manufacturer’s TV using an HDMI connection, select MENU → (Setup) → [HDMI Settings] → [CTRL FOR HDMI] → [Off].
603
Help Guide
You can set how to record movies and perform HDMI output when your camera is connected to 4K-compatible external
recording/playback devices, etc.
Note
This item can be set only when the camera is in movie mode and connected to a 4K-compatible device.
When [HDMI Only(30p)], [HDMI Only(24p)] or [HDMI Only(25p)] is set, [HDMI Info. Display] will temporarily be set to [Off].
A 4K movie is not output to the connected 4K-compatible device during slow-motion/quick-motion shooting.
When [HDMI Only(30p)], [HDMI Only(24p)] or [HDMI Only(25p)] is set, the counter does not move forward (the actual recording
time is not counted) while the movie is being recorded on an external recording/playback device.
When [ File Format] is set to [XAVC S 4K] and the camera is connected via HDMI, the following functions are not available.
[Face/Eye Prty in AF]
[Face Prty in Mlti Mtr]
[Center Lock-on AF]
Related Topic
HDMI Settings: REC Control (movie)
File Format (movie)
Record Setting (movie)
HDMI Settings: HDMI Info. Display
604
Help Guide
USB Connection
Selects the USB connection method when this product is connected to a computer, etc.
Select MENU → (Network) → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] → [Ctrl w/ Smartphone] → [Off] beforehand.
PC Remote:
Uses Imaging Edge to control the product from a computer, including such functions as shooting and storing images on
the computer.
Note
It may take some time to make the connection between this product and a computer when [USB Connection] is set to [Auto].
Related Topic
PC Remote Settings: Still Img. Save Dest.
PC Remote Settings: RAW+J PC Save Img
605
Help Guide
606
Help Guide
Sets whether to supply power via the USB cable when the product is connected to a computer or an USB device.
Note
Insert the battery pack into the product to supply power via USB cable.
607
Help Guide
Sets whether to save still images stored in both the camera and the computer during PC Remote shooting. This setting
is useful when you want to check recorded images on the camera without leaving the camera.
* PC Remote: Uses Imaging Edge to control the product from a computer, including such functions as shooting and storing images on the
computer.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [PC Remote Settings] → [Still Img. Save Dest.] → desired setting.
Note
During PC Remote shooting, you cannot change settings for [Still Img. Save Dest.]. Adjust the settings before you start shooting.
If you insert a memory card that is not recordable, you cannot shoot still images even if you select [PC+Camera].
If you select [PC+Camera] and you have not inserted a memory card into the camera, you cannot release the shutter even if
[Release w/o Card] is set to [Enable].
During PC Remote shooting, [Recording Mode] under [Rec. Media Settings] is locked to [Standard] and cannot be changed.
While you are playing back still images on the camera, you cannot shoot using PC Remote.
Related Topic
USB Connection
Release w/o Card
PC Remote Settings: RAW+J PC Save Img
608
Help Guide
Selects the file type for images to be transferred to the computer in PC Remote shooting.
When shooting still images using PC Remote, the application on the computer does not display the image until the
image has been completely transferred. When performing RAW+JPEG shooting, you can accelerate the display
processing speed by transferring only JPEG images instead of transferring both RAW and JPEG images.
* PC Remote: Uses Imaging Edge to control the product from a computer, including such functions as shooting and storing images on the
computer.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [PC Remote Settings] → [RAW+J PC Save Img] → desired setting.
Note
The setting for [RAW+J PC Save Img] cannot be changed during PC Remote shooting. Adjust the setting before shooting.
[RAW+J PC Save Img] can be set only when [ File Format] is set to [RAW & JPEG].
During PC Remote shooting, [Recording Mode] under [Rec. Media Settings] is locked to [Standard] and cannot be changed.
Related Topic
USB Connection
File Format (still image)
PC Remote Settings: Still Img. Save Dest.
609
Help Guide
Language
Selects the language to be used in the menu items, warnings and messages.
610
Help Guide
Date/Time Setup
The Clock Set screen is displayed automatically when you turn on this product for the first time or when the internal
rechargeable backup battery has fully discharged. Select this menu when setting the date and time after the first time.
Hint
To charge the internal rechargeable backup battery, insert a charged battery pack, and leave the product for 24 hours or more
with the power off.
If the clock resets every time the battery is charged, the internal rechargeable backup battery may be worn out. Consult your
service facility.
611
Help Guide
Area Setting
612
Help Guide
Copyright Info
2 When you select [Set Photographer] or [Set Copyright], a keyboard appears on the screen. Enter your
desired name.
Set Photographer:
Sets the photographer name.
Set Copyright:
Sets the copyright holder name.
Disp. Copyright Info:
Displays the current copyright information.
Note
You can only enter alphanumeric characters and symbols for [Set Photographer] and [Set Copyright]. You can enter up to 46
letters.
In order to prevent unauthorized use of [Copyright Info], be sure to clear the [Set Photographer] and [Set Copyright] columns
before lending out or handing over your camera.
Sony is not liable for problems or damages resulting from use of [Copyright Info].
Related Topic
How to use the keyboard
613
Help Guide
Format
When you use a memory card with this camera for the first time, we recommend that you format the card using the
camera for stable performance of the memory card. Note that formatting permanently erases all data on the memory
card, and is unrecoverable. Save valuable data on a computer, etc.
Note
Formatting permanently erases all data including protected images and registered settings (from M1 to M4).
The access lamp lights up during formatting. Do not remove the memory card while the access lamp is lit up.
Format the memory card on this camera. If you format the memory card on the computer, the memory card may not be usable
depending on the format type.
It may take a few minutes to complete formatting, depending on the memory card.
You cannot format the memory card if the remaining battery charge is less than 1%.
614
Help Guide
File Number
Hint
The setting for [File Number] will be applied to both slot 1 and slot 2.
Even if you change the setting of [Prioritize Rec. Media], the file numbers will be sequential across the two memory cards in each
slot by setting [File Number] to [Series].
615
Help Guide
You can specify the first three characters of the file name for images you shoot.
2 Select the entry field for the file name to display a keyboard on the screen, and then enter three characters
of your choice.
The setting for [Set File Name] will be applied to both slot 1 and slot 2.
Note
Only capital letters, numbers, and underscores can be entered. However, an underscore cannot be used as the first character.
The three characters of the file name you specify using [Set File Name] will only be applied to images you shoot after changing
the setting.
Related Topic
How to use the keyboard
616
Help Guide
Selects the memory card slot on which to record. [Slot 1] is the default setting. If you do not intend to change the settings
and will only use one memory card, use the slot 1.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] → [Prioritize Rec. Media] → desired slot.
Hint
To record the same image on two memory cards at the same time or to sort recorded images onto two memory card slots by the
image type (still image/movie), use [Recording Mode].
Note
The slot 2 supports Memory Stick PRO Duo media and SD cards. The slot 1 supports SD cards only.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
617
Help Guide
You can select the method for recording an image, such as recording the same image simultaneously to two memory
cards or recording different types of images to two memory cards.
Hint
Even when [Recording Mode] is set to [Sort(RAW/JPEG)] or [Sort(JPEG/RAW)], if [RAW & JPEG] is not selected under [ File
Format], only files of the selected format will be recorded.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
618
Help Guide
If a memory card in use becomes full or you have forgotten to insert a memory card into a slot, you can record images to
the other memory card.
1 MENU → (Setup) → [Rec. Media Settings] → [Auto Switch Media] → desired setting.
: Recording images
(A): Recording is no longer possible on the memory card (due to lack of capacity, etc.).
(B): The memory card is replaced with a recordable one.
The camera stops simultaneous recording when either of the memory cards becomes full. When you remove the
memory card that has become full, the camera starts recording to the other memory card.
When you replace the memory card that has become full with a recordable memory card, the camera starts
simultaneous recording with the selected setting again.
619
Example: When [Prioritize Rec. Media] is set to [Slot 1]
([Recording Mode]: [Simult. ( / )])
Images that are not recorded simultaneously (for example: still images during [Simult. ( )]) continue to be
recorded to the other memory card when the memory card in use becomes full.
When the memory card in use becomes full while recording a movie, the movie continues to be recorded to the other
memory card until the recording in progress is finished.
When recording images separately to two memory cards in the RAW and JPEG formats:
When [Recording Mode] is set to [Sort(RAW/JPEG)] or [Sort(JPEG/RAW)], and [ File Format] is set to [RAW &
JPEG]
The camera stops recording when either of the memory cards becomes full. When you remove the memory card that
has become full, the camera starts recording both in the RAW and JPEG formats to the other memory card.
When you replace the memory card that has become full with a recordable memory card, the camera starts recording
the two types of images separately with the selected setting again.
620
(C): A recordable memory card is inserted.
When the memory card in use becomes full while recording movies, the camera starts recording to the other memory
card.
When recording still images and movies separately to two memory cards:
When either of the memory cards becomes full, both still images and movies are recorded to the other memory card.
When you replace the memory card that has become full with a recordable memory card, the camera starts recording
the two types of images separately with the selected setting again.
Hint
Images are recorded to the memory card in the slot displayed on the monitor with an arrow symbol. After the camera switches
the slot using [Auto Switch Media], replace the memory card in the former slot with a recordable memory card.
If [Recording Mode] is set to [Standard], the setting for [Prioritize Rec. Media] will switch automatically when the slot switches. If
you want to record on the slot in use before switching, select the desired slot again using [Prioritize Rec. Media].
If you want to continually record with the settings selected with [Recording Mode] and [Prioritize Rec. Media], set [Auto Switch
Media] to [Off].
Even when the camera records a movie on two memory cards using [Auto Switch Media], the continuous recordable time is
approximately 29 minutes per recording.
Related Topic
Memory cards that can be used
Recordable movie times
Rec. Media Settings: Prioritize Rec. Media
621
Help Guide
If [Folder Name] is set to [Standard Form] and there are 2 folders or more, you can select the folder on the memory card
to which images are to be recorded.
Note
You cannot select the folder when [Folder Name] is set to [Date Form].
If [Recording Mode] is set to other than [Standard], you may only select the common folder on the both memory cards. If there is
no common folder, you can make one using [New Folder].
Related Topic
Folder Name
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
622
Help Guide
New Folder
Creates a new folder on the memory card for recording still images. A new folder is created with a folder number one
greater than the largest folder number currently used. Images are recorded in the newly created folder.
Note
When you insert a memory card that was used with other equipment into this product and shoot images, a new folder may be
automatically created.
Up to 4,000 images in total can be stored in one folder. When the folder capacity is exceeded, a new folder may be automatically
created.
If [Recording Mode] is set to other than [Standard], a new folder is created with a folder number one greater than the largest
folder number currently used on both memory cards inserted in the memory card slots.
If [Recording Mode] is set to other than [Standard] and an image is shot, a new folder may be automatically created.
Related Topic
Rec. Media Settings: Recording Mode
623
Help Guide
Folder Name
Still images are recorded in a folder that is automatically created inside the DCIM folder on the memory card. You can
change the way folder names are assigned.
Note
You cannot change the [Folder Name] settings for movies.
624
Help Guide
Recover Image DB
If image files were processed on a computer, problems may occur in the image database file. In such cases, the images
on the memory card will not be played back on this product. If these problems happen, repair the file using [Recover
Image DB].
1 MENU → (Setup) → [Recover Image DB] → desired memory card slot → [Enter].
Note
Use a sufficiently charged battery pack. Low battery power during repairing can cause damage to data.
625
Help Guide
Displays the recordable time of movies for the inserted memory card. Also displays the number of recordable still images
for the inserted memory card.
626
Help Guide
Version
Displays the version of this product’s software. Check the version when updates for this product’s software are released,
etc.
Also displays the version of the lens if a lens compatible with firmware updates is attached.
The version of the Mount Adaptor is displayed in the lens area if a Mount Adaptor compatible with firmware updates is
attached.
Note
Updating can be performed only when the battery level is (3 remaining battery bars) or more. Use a sufficiently charged
battery pack.
627
Help Guide
Setting Reset
Resets the product to the default settings. Even if you perform [Setting Reset], the recorded images are retained.
Note
Be sure not to eject the battery pack while resetting.
The value set with [AF Micro Adj.] will not be reset even when [Camera Settings Reset] or [Initialize] is performed.
Settings of [Picture Profile] will not be reset even when [Camera Settings Reset] or [Initialize] is performed.
Related Topic
AF Micro Adj.
List of default setting values
628
Help Guide
Add Item
You can register the desired menu items to (My Menu) under MENU.
2 Select an item that you want to add to (My Menu) using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control
wheel.
Hint
You can add up to 30 items to (My Menu).
Note
You cannot add the following items to (My Menu).
Any item under MENU → (Playback)
[View on TV]
Related Topic
Sort Item
Delete Item
Using MENU items
629
Help Guide
Sort Item
You can rearrange the menu items added to (My Menu) under MENU.
2 Select an item that you want to move using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control wheel.
Related Topic
Add Item
630
Help Guide
Delete Item
2 Select an item that you want to delete using the top/bottom/left/right sides of the control wheel, and then
press the center to delete the selected item.
Hint
To delete all the items on a page, select MENU → (My Menu) → [Delete Page].
You can delete all the items added to (My Menu) by selecting MENU → (My Menu) → [Delete All].
Related Topic
Delete Page
Delete All
Add Item
631
Help Guide
Delete Page
You can delete all the menu items added to a page under (My Menu) in MENU.
2 Select a page that you want to delete using the left/right sides of the control wheel, and then press the
center of the control wheel to delete the items.
Related Topic
Add Item
Delete All
632
Help Guide
Delete All
You can delete all the menu items added to (My Menu) in MENU.
2 Select [OK].
Related Topic
Add Item
Delete Page
633
Help Guide
Precautions
Refer also to “Notes on using your camera” in the Instruction Manual (supplied) for this product.
Data may be corrupted in the following cases. Be sure to back up the data for protection.
When the memory card is removed, the USB cable is disconnected, or the product is turned off in the middle of a
read or write operation.
When the memory card is used in locations subject to static electricity or electrical noise.
If you insert a memory card that does not contain an image database file into the product and turn on the power, the
product automatically creates an image database file using some of the memory card’s capacity. The process may take a
long time and you cannot operate the product until the process is completed.
If a database file error occurs, export all images to your computer using PlayMemories Home, and then format the
memory card using this product.
On storing
If the camera is dirty after use, clean it. Water, sand, dust, salt, etc. left in the camera may cause a malfunction.
Precaution on carrying
Do not carry the camera with the tripod attached. This may cause the tripod socket hole to break.
Do not apply excessive force to the camera, such as by holding the monitor or flash part, hitting the lens part, etc.
On operating temperatures
Shooting in extremely cold or hot places that exceed this range is not recommended.
On moisture condensation
If the product is brought directly from a cold to a warm location, moisture may condense inside or outside the
product. This moisture condensation may cause a malfunction of the product.
To prevent moisture condensation when you bring the product directly from a cold to a warm location, first put it in a
plastic bag and seal it to prevent air from entering. Wait for about an hour until the temperature of the product has
634
reached the ambient temperature.
If moisture condensation occurs, turn off the product and wait about an hour for the moisture to evaporate. Note that
if you attempt to shoot with moisture remaining inside the lens, you will be unable to record clear images.
This product conforms with DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) universal standard established by JEITA (Japan
Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association).
Network services, content, and the [operating system and] software of this Product may be subject to individual terms
and conditions and changed, interrupted or discontinued at any time and may require fees, registration and credit card
information.
635
Help Guide
On cleaning
Do not use a cleaning solution containing organic solvents, such as thinner, or benzine.
When cleaning the lens surface, remove dust with a commercially available blower. In case of dust that sticks to the
surface, wipe it off with a soft cloth or tissue paper slightly moistened with lens cleaning solution. Wipe in a spiral
pattern from the center to the outside. Do not spray lens cleaning solution directly onto the lens surface.
Do not touch the parts of the product inside the lens mount, such as a lens signal contact. To clean inside the lens
mount, use a commercially available blower* to blow any dust off.
* Do not use a spray-type blower as doing so may cause a malfunction.
Clean the product surface with a soft cloth slightly moistened with water, then wipe the surface with a dry cloth. To
prevent damage to the finish or casing:
Do not expose the product to chemical products such as thinner, benzine, alcohol, disposable cloths, insect repellent,
sunscreen or insecticide.
Do not touch the product with any of the above on your hand.
Do not leave the product in contact with rubber or vinyl for a long time.
If you wipe the monitor firmly using tissue paper, etc., the coating may be scratched.
If the monitor becomes dirty with fingerprints or dust, gently remove the dust from the surface, and then clean the
monitor using soft cloth, etc.
636
Help Guide
Cleaning Mode
If dust or debris gets inside the camera and adheres to the surface of the image sensor (the part that converts the light to
an electric signal), it may appear as dark spots on the image, depending on the shooting environment. If this happens,
follow the steps below to clean the image sensor.
5 Use the blower to clean the image sensor surface and the surrounding area.
Hint
For how to check the amount of dust on the image sensor, and for further details on cleaning methods, please refer to the
following URL.
http://support.d-imaging.sony.co.jp/www/support/ilc/sensor/index.php
Note
Clean the image sensor quickly.
A blower is not supplied with this product. Use a commercially available blower.
Make sure that the remaining battery level is (3 remaining battery icons) or more, before performing the cleaning. The use
of AC adaptor (supplied) is recommended.
Do not use a spray type blower as it may scatter water droplets inside the camera body.
Do not put the tip of a blower into the cavity beyond the lens mount area, so that the tip of the blower does not touch the image
sensor.
637
Hold the camera slightly face downward so that the dust falls out.
When cleaning the image sensor with a blower, do not blow too hard. If you blow the sensor too hard, the inside of the product
may be damaged.
If the dust remains even after you cleaned the product as described, consult the service facility.
Related Topic
Troubleshooting
638
Help Guide
When you insert a memory card into the camera and set the ON/OFF (Power) switch to “ON,” the number of images that
can be recorded (should you continue to shoot using the current settings) is displayed on the screen.
Note
When “0” (the number of recordable images) flashes in orange, the memory card is full. Replace the memory card with another
one, or delete images from the current memory card.
When “NO CARD” flashes in orange, it means no memory card has been inserted. Insert a memory card.
*1 When [ Aspect Ratio] is set to other than [3:2], you can record more images than the numbers shown in the table above. (except when
[RAW] is selected)
*2 [ JPEG Quality] when [RAW & JPEG] is selected: [Fine]
Note
Even if the number of recordable images is higher than 9999 images, “9999” will appear.
639
Help Guide
The table below shows the approximate total recording times using a memory card formatted with this camera. The
values may vary depending on the shooting conditions and the type of memory card used.
The recording times for when [ File Format] is set to [XAVC S 4K] and [XAVC S HD] are recording times when
shooting with [ Proxy Recording] set to [Off].
(h (hour), m (minute))
8 GB 32 GB 64 GB 256 GB
The times for slow-motion/quick-motion movies are playback times, not recording times.
Note
The recordable time of movies varies because the camera is equipped with VBR (Variable Bit-Rate), which automatically adjusts
image quality depending on the shooting scene. When you record a fast-moving subject, the image is clearer but the recordable
time is shorter because more memory is required for recording. The recordable time also varies depending on the shooting
conditions, the subject or the image quality/size settings.
The times shown are recordable times using a Sony memory card.
640
Notes on continuous movie recording
High-quality movie recording and high-speed continuous shooting require large amounts of power. Therefore, if you
continue to shoot, the temperature inside the camera will rise, especially that of the image sensor. In such cases, the
camera will turn off automatically because the surface of the camera is heated to a high temperature or the high
temperature affects the quality of the images or the internal mechanism of the camera.
The duration of time available for continuous movie recording when the camera records with the default settings after
the power has been turned off for a while is as follows. The values indicate the continuous time from when the
camera starts recording until the camera stops recording.
The duration of time available for movie recording varies with the temperature, file format/record setting for movies,
Wi-Fi network environment, or condition of the camera before you start recording. If you frequently recompose or
shoot images after the power is turned on, the temperature inside the camera will rise and the recording time
available will be shorter.
If the icon appears, the temperature of the camera has risen.
If the camera stops movie recording due to a high temperature, leave it for some time with the power turned off. Start
recording after the temperature inside the camera drops fully.
If you observe the following points, you will be able to record movies for longer periods of time.
Keep the camera out of direct sunlight.
Turn the camera off when it is not being used.
When [ File Format] is set to [AVCHD], the file size of movies is limited to approx. 2 GB. If the movie file size
reaches approx. 2 GB during recording, a new movie file will be created automatically.
641
Help Guide
You can use the battery charger (sold separately) and the AC Adaptor (supplied) in any country or region where the
power supply is within 100 V to 240 V AC and 50 Hz/60 Hz.
Depending on the country/region, a converting plug adaptor may be needed to connect to a wall outlet (wall socket).
Consult a travel agency, etc., and prepare one in advance.
Note
Do not use an electronic voltage transformer as doing so may cause a malfunction.
642
Help Guide
AVCHD format
The AVCHD format was developed for high-definition digital video cameras when recording an HD (High-Definition)
signal using high-efficiency compression coding technology. The MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 format is used to compress video
data, and the Dolby Digital or Linear PCM system is used to compress audio data.
The MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 format is capable of compressing images at higher efficiency than that of the conventional
image compressing format.
As the AVCHD format uses compression coding technology, the picture may be unstable in scenes where the screen,
angle of view, or brightness, etc. change drastically, but this is not a malfunction.
643
Help Guide
License
This product comes with software that are used based on licensing agreements with the owners of that software. Based
on requests by the owners of copyright of these software applications, we have an obligation to inform you of the
following. Licenses (in English) are recorded in the internal memory of your product. Establish a Mass Storage
connection between the product and a computer to read licenses in the “PMHOME” - “LICENSE” folder.
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL USE OF A
CONSUMER OR OTHER USES IN WHICH IT DOES NOT RECEIVE REMUNERATION TO
(i) ENCODE VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”)
AND/OR
(ii) DECODE AVC VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL ACTIVITY AND/OR
WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO.
NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
INCLUDING THAT RELATING TO PROMOTIONAL, INTERNAL AND COMMERCIAL USES AND LICENSING MAY BE
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C.
SEE HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM
644
Help Guide
Specifications
Camera
[System]
Camera Type
Interchangeable Lens Digital Camera
Lens
Sony E-mount lens
[Image sensor]
Image format
35 mm full frame (35.6 mm × 23.8 mm), CMOS image sensor
Effective pixel number of camera
Approx. 24 200 000 pixels
Total pixel number of camera
Approx. 25 300 000 pixels
[SteadyShot]
System
In-camera sensor shift image stabilization system
[Anti-Dust]
System
Charge protection coating on optical filter and image sensor shift mechanism
[Electronic Viewfinder]
Type
1.3 cm (0.5 type) Electronic Viewfinder
Total number of dots
2 359 296 dots
Frame coverage
100%
Magnification
Approx. 0.78× with 50 mm lens at infinity, –1 m-1
Eye Point
Approx. 23 mm from the eyepiece and approx. 18.5 mm from the eyepiece frame at –1 m-1
Diopter Adjustment
645
–4.0 m-1 to +3.0 m-1
[Monitor]
LCD monitor
7.5 cm (3.0 type) TFT drive, touch panel
Total number of dots
921 600 dots
[Exposure control]
Metering method
1 200-zone evaluative metering
Metering Range
–3 EV to +20 EV (at ISO 100 equivalent with F2.0 lens)
ISO sensitivity (Recommended exposure index)
Still images: ISO 100 to ISO 51 200 (Extended ISO: Minimum ISO 50, maximum ISO 204 800), [ISO AUTO] (ISO 100 to
12 800, Maximum/Minimum can be set.)
Movies: ISO 100 to ISO 51 200 equivalent, [ISO AUTO] (ISO 100 to ISO 12 800 equivalent, Maximum/Minimum can be
set.)
Exposure compensation
±5.0 EV (switchable between 1/3 EV and 1/2 EV steps)
When using exposure compensation dial: ±3.0 EV (1/3 EV step)
[Shutter]
Type
Electronically-controlled, vertical-traverse, focal-plane type
Speed range
Still images: 1/8 000 second to 30 seconds, BULB
Movies: 1/8 000 second to 1/4 second (1/3 EV step)
1080 60i-compatible devices (1080 50i-compatible devices): up to 1/60 (1/50) second in AUTO mode (up to 1/30
(1/25) second in Auto slow shutter mode)
[Continuous shooting]
Continuous shooting speed
: Maximum of approx. 10 images per second/ : Maximum of approx. 8 images per second/ : Maximum of
approx. 6 images per second/ : Maximum of approx. 3 images per second
Based on our measurement conditions. The speed of continuous shooting can be slower, depending on the shooting
conditions.
[Recording format]
File format
JPEG (DCF Ver. 2.0, Exif Ver. 2.31, MPF Baseline) compliant, RAW (Sony ARW 2.3 format)
Movie (XAVC S format)
MPEG-4 AVC/H.264 XAVC S ver.1.0 format compliant
Video: MPEG-4 AVC/H.264
Audio: LPCM 2ch (48kHz 16bit)
Movie (AVCHD format)
AVCHD format Ver. 2.0 compatible
Video: MPEG-4 AVC/H.264
Audio: Dolby Digital 2ch, equipped with Dolby Digital Stereo Creator
646
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.
[Recording media]
Memory Stick, SD cards
[Slot]
SLOT 1
Slot for SD cards (UHS-I and UHS-II compatible)
SLOT 2
Multi-slot for Memory Stick PRO Duo and SD cards (UHS-I compatible)
Supports operations between two memory cards.
[Input/output terminals]
USB Type-C terminal
SuperSpeed USB (USB 3.1 Gen 1)
Multi/Micro USB Terminal*
Hi-Speed USB (USB 2.0)
* Supports Micro USB compatible devices.
HDMI
HDMI type D micro jack
(Microphone) terminal
Ø 3.5 mm Stereo mini jack
(Headphones) terminal
Ø 3.5 mm Stereo mini jack
[Power, general]
Model No.
WW541200
Rated input
7.2 V
Power consumption (while shooting)
Using an FE 28-70 mm F3.5-5.6 OSS
When using the viewfinder: Approx. 3.2 W
When using the monitor: Approx. 2.8 W
Operating temperature
0 to 40°C (32 to 104°F)
Storage temperature
–20 to 55°C (–4 to 131°F)
Dimensions (W/H/D) (Approx.)
126.9 × 95.6 × 73.7 mm
126.9 × 95.6 × 62.7 mm (from grip to monitor)
5 × 3 7/8 × 3 in.
5 × 3 7/8 × 2 1/2 in. (from grip to monitor)
Mass (CIPA compliant) (Approx.)
650 g (1 lb 7.0 oz) (including battery pack, SD card)
Microphone
Stereo
Speaker
Monaural
Exif Print
Compatible
DPOF
Compatible
PRINT Image Matching III
647
Compatible
[Wireless LAN]
Supported format
IEEE 802.11 b/g/n
Frequency band
2.4 GHz
Security
WEP/WPA-PSK/WPA2-PSK
Connection method
Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ (WPS)/Manual
Access method
Infrastructure mode
[NFC]
Tag type
NFC Forum Type 3 Tag compliant
[Bluetooth communications]
Bluetooth standard Ver. 4.1
Frequency band
2.4 GHz
AC Adaptor AC-UUD12/AC-UUE12
Rated input
100 – 240 V , 50/60 Hz, 0.2 A
Rated output
5V , 1.5 A
Rated voltage
7.2 V
Focal length
28 mm – 70 mm
Lens groups – elements
8–9
Angle of view
75° – 34°
Minimum focus*
0.3 m – 0.45 m (0.99 ft. – 1.48 ft.)
* Minimum focus is the shortest distance from the image sensor to the subject.
Maximum magnification
0.19×
Minimum aperture
f/22 – f/36
Filter diameter
55 mm
Dimensions (max. diameter × height)
Approx. 72.5 mm × 83 mm (Approx. 2 7/8 inches × 3 3/8 inches)
Mass
648
Approx. 295 g (Approx. 10.5 oz.)
SteadyShot
Available
649
Help Guide
Trademarks
650
Help Guide
Camera Settings1
Long Exposure NR On
/ Recall ― ―
651
Default setting Resettable using [Camera
MENU items
value Settings Reset]
/ Memory ― ―
Balanced
Priority Set in AF-S ―
Emphasis
Balanced
Priority Set in AF-C ―
Emphasis
Focus Settings ―
AF Illuminator Auto
Phase
AF System ―
Detection AF
AF w/ shutter On ―
Pre-AF Off ―
Eye-Start AF Off ―
652
Default setting Resettable using [Camera
MENU items
value Settings Reset]
Exp.comp.set Ambient&flash ―
D-Range
DRO/Auto HDR
Optimizer: Auto
653
Default setting Resettable using [Camera
MENU items
value Settings Reset]
Focus Magnifier ―
AF in Focus Mag. On ―
MF Assist On ―
Face Registration ― ―
Camera Settings2
60i 17M(FH)/50i
Record Setting (when [ File Format] is set to [AVCHD])
17M(FH)
Audio Recording On
654
Default setting Resettable using [Camera
MENU items
value Settings Reset]
SteadyShot On
Zoom ― ―
Optical zoom
Zoom Setting ―
only
FINDER/MONITOR Auto ―
655
Default setting Resettable using [Camera
MENU items
value Settings Reset]
Touch Operation
Custom Key (Custom Button 4) ―
Sel.
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Control Wheel) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Custom Button 1) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Custom Button 2) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Custom Button 3) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Custom Button 4) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Multi-Slc Center Btn) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Center Button) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Left Button) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Right Button) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Down Button) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (AEL Button) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (AF-ON Button) ―
)
Follow Custom (
Custom Key (Focus Hold Button) ―
)
Fllw. Cust. ( /
Custom Key (Custom Button 1) ―
)
Fllw. Cust. ( /
Custom Key (Custom Button 2) ―
)
656
Default setting Resettable using [Camera
MENU items
value Settings Reset]
Send to
Custom Key (Fn/ Button) ―
Smartphone
Dial Setup Av Tv ―
Audio signals On ―
Network
To reset the items for [Network] to the default values, select [Initialize] or [Reset Network Set.]. These items are not reset
to the default values even if you select [Camera Settings Reset].
Send to Computer ―
View on TV ―
Loc. Info. Link Set. (Auto Time Correct.) (when [Location Info. Link] is set to [On]) On
657
MENU items Default setting value
Loc. Info. Link Set. (Auto Area Adjust.) (when [Location Info. Link] is set to [On]) On
Playback
To reset the items for [Playback] to the default values, select [Initialize]. These items are not reset to the default values
even if you select [Camera Settings Reset].
Protect ―
Rotate ―
Delete ―
Rating ―
Specify Printing ―
Copy ―
Photo Capture ―
Enlarge Image ―
Setup
658
To reset the items for [Setup] to the default values, select [Initialize]. These items are not reset to the default values even
if you select [Camera Settings Reset].
Volume Settings 7
NTSC/PAL Selector ―
Cleaning Mode ―
659
MENU items Default setting value
Language ―
Date/Time Setup ―
Area Setting ―
Format ―
New Folder ―
Version ―
Setting Reset ―
My Menu
To reset the items for [My Menu] to the default values, select [Initialize] or [Delete All]. These items are not reset to the
default values even if you select [Camera Settings Reset].
Add Item ―
Sort Item ―
Delete Item ―
660
MENU items Default setting value
Delete Page ―
Delete All ―
661
Help Guide
Troubleshooting
If you experience trouble with the product, try the following solutions.
1 Remove the battery pack, wait for about one minute, re-insert the battery pack, then turn on the power.
3 Consult your dealer or local authorized service facility. Additional information on this product and answers
to frequently asked questions can be found at our Customer Support Website.
http://www.sony.net/
Related Topic
Setting Reset
662
Help Guide
Warning messages
Set Area/Date/Time.
Set the area, date and time. If you have not used the product for a long time, charge the internal rechargeable
backup battery.
Power insufficient.
The image copying or the image sensor cleaning function will not operate because the remaining battery level is too
low. Recharge the battery pack or supply power using an AC Adaptor.
The memory card was formatted on a computer and the file format was modified. Select [Enter] and then format the
memory card. You can use the memory card again, however, all previous data in the memory card is erased. It may
take some time to complete the format. If the message still appears, change the memory card.
You are using a memory card with a write-protect switch or a delete-protect switch with the switch set to the LOCK
position. Set the switch to the record position.
Cannot open the shutter since the memory card is not inserted.
No memory card has been inserted into the memory card slot selected in [Prioritize Rec. Media].
To release the shutter without inserting a memory card into the camera, set [Release w/o Card] to [Enable]. In this
case, images will not be saved.
This memory card may not be capable of recording and playing normally.
Processing...
When performing noise reduction, the reduction process takes place. You cannot do any further shooting during this
reduction process.
Unable to display.
Images recorded with other products or images modified with a computer may not be displayed.
Processing on the computer such as deletion of the image files may cause inconsistencies in the image database
files. Repair the image database files.
663
Check that a lens is mounted. For an unsupported lens, set "Release w/o Lens" in the menu to "Enable".
The lens is not attached properly, or the lens is not attached. If the message appears when a lens is attached,
reattach the lens. If the message appears frequently, check whether the contacts of the lens and product are clean or
not.
When attaching the product to an astronomical telescope or similar instrument, or using an unsupported lens, set
[Release w/o Lens] to [Enable].
Unable to print.
The product has become hot because you have been shooting continuously. Turn the power off and cool the product
and wait until the product is ready to shoot again.
You have been recording images for a long time, the product temperature has risen.
The number of images exceeds that for which date management in a database file by the product is possible.
Unable to register to the database file. Import all the images to a computer using PlayMemories Home and recover
the memory card.
There is something wrong in the Image Database File. Select [Setup] → [Recover Image DB].
System Error
Camera Error. Turn power off then on.
Remove the battery pack, and then re-insert it. If the message appears frequently, consult local authorized Sony
service facility.
You cannot record and play back an AVCHD movie because the Image Database File is damaged. Recover the
Image Database File following the on-screen instructions.
Unable to magnify.
Unable to rotate image.
A folder in the memory card has the first three digits “999.” You cannot create any more folders on this camera.
Related Topic
Notes on memory card
Format
Release w/o Lens
664
4-732-947-15(1) Copyright 2018 Sony Corporation
665
Help Guide
Recommended pages
666